blob: 75c17bee96188477d074f74694993c8d10b74336 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8860dcd2014-04-26 00:08:14 +02007 2014/04/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100500 - tune.zlib.memlevel
501 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503 * Debugging
504 - debug
505 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506
507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005083.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200509------------------------------------
510
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200511ca-base <dir>
512 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200513 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
514 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200515
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516chroot <jail dir>
517 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
518 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
519 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
520 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
521 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
522 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100523
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100524cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
525 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
526 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
527 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100528 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
529 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
530 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
531 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
532 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
533 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
534 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
535 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
536 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
537 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100538
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200539crt-base <dir>
540 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
541 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
542 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
543
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544daemon
545 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
546 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
547 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
548
549gid <number>
550 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
551 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
552 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100553 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
554 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200555 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100556
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557group <group name>
558 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
559 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100560
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200561log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
563 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100564 configured with "log global".
565
566 <address> can be one of:
567
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100568 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100569 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
570 port).
571
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100572 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
573 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
574 port).
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
577 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
578 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
579 writeable).
580
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100581 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
582 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
583 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
584 in Bourne shell.
585
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100586 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587
588 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
589 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
590 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
591
592 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200593 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
594 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
595 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
596 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
597 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
598 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200600 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100602log-send-hostname [<string>]
603 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
604 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
605 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
606 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
607 the logs.
608
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000609log-tag <string>
610 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
611 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
612 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
613 running on the same host.
614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615nbproc <number>
616 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
617 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
618 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
619 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
620 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
621
622pidfile <pidfile>
623 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
624 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
625 starting the process. See also "daemon".
626
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100627stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200628 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
629 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
630 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
631 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
632 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
633 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100634 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
635 word size (32 or 64).
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200636
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100637ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
639 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300640 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100641 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
642 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
643 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
644 "bind" keyword for more information.
645
646ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
647 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
648 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300649 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100650 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
651 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
652 information.
653
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100654ssl-server-verify [none|required]
655 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
656 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
657 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
658
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200659stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
660 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
661 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
662 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
663 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200664
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200665 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
666 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
667 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200668
669stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
670 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
671 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100672 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200673
674stats maxconn <connections>
675 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
676 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
677
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678uid <number>
679 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
680 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
681 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
682 one. See also "gid" and "user".
683
684ulimit-n <number>
685 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
686 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
687 option.
688
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100689unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
690 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
691
692 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
693 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
694 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
695 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
696 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
697 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
698 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
699 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
700 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
701 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703user <user name>
704 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
705 See also "uid" and "group".
706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200707node <name>
708 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
709
710 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
711 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
712 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
713 traffic.
714
715description <text>
716 Add a text that describes the instance.
717
718 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
719 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
720 "<" and ">" characters.
721
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007233.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200724-----------------------
725
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200726max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
727 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
728 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
729 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
730 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
731 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
732 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
733 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
734 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
735
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200736maxconn <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
738 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
739 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
740 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
741
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200742maxconnrate <number>
743 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
744 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
745 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
746 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
747 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
748 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
749 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
750 fairness.
751
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100752maxcomprate <number>
753 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300754 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100755 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
756 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
757 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
758 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
759 default value.
760
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100761maxcompcpuusage <number>
762 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
763 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
764 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
765 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
766 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
767 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
768 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
769 process down and from introducing high latencies.
770
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100771maxpipes <number>
772 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
773 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
774 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
775 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
776 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
777 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
778
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200779maxsessrate <number>
780 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
781 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
782 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
783 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
784 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
785 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
786 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
787 fairness.
788
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200789maxsslconn <number>
790 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
791 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
792 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
793 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
794 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
795 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
796 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
797
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200798maxsslrate <number>
799 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
800 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
801 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
802 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
803 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
804 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
805 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
806 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
807 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
808 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
809
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100810maxzlibmem <number>
811 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
812 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
813 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100814 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
815 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
816 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818noepoll
819 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
820 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100821 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822
823nokqueue
824 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
825 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
826 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
827
828nopoll
829 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
830 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100831 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100832 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200833
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100834nosplice
835 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
836 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
837 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100838 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100839 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
840 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
841 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
842 "option splice-response".
843
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300844nogetaddrinfo
845 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
846 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
847
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200848spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900849 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
850 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
851 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
852 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
853 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
854 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200855
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200856tune.bufsize <number>
857 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
858 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
859 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
860 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
861 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
862 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
863 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
864 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400865 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
866 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
867 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200868
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200869tune.chksize <number>
870 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
871 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
872 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
873 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
874 checks whenever possible.
875
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100876tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
877 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
878 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
879 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
880 this value. The default value is 1.
881
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100882tune.http.cookielen <number>
883 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
884 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
885 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
886 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
887 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
888 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
889 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
890 to change this value.
891
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200892tune.http.maxhdr <number>
893 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
894 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
895 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
896 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
897 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
898 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
899 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
900 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
901 limit too high.
902
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100903tune.idletimer <timeout>
904 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
905 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
906 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
907 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
908 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
909 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
910 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
911 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
912 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
913
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100914tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100915 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
916 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
917 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
918 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
919 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
920 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
921 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
922 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
923 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
924 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100925
926tune.maxpollevents <number>
927 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
928 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
929 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
930 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
931 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
932
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200933tune.maxrewrite <number>
934 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
935 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
936 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
937 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
938 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
939 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
940 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
941 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
942 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
943 bufsize.
944
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200945tune.pipesize <number>
946 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
947 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
948 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
949 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
950 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
951 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
952
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100953tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
954tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
955 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
956 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
957 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
958 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
959 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
960 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
961 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
962
963tune.sndbuf.client <number>
964tune.sndbuf.server <number>
965 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
966 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
967 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
968 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
969 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
970 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
971 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
972 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
973 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
974 notifying haproxy again.
975
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100976tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100977 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
978 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
979 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300980 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100981 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
982 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
983 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
984 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
985 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100986 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
987 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100988
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200989tune.ssl.force-private-cache
990 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
991 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
992 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
993 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
994 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
995 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
996
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100997tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
998 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300999 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001000 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1001 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1002 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1003 being used for too long.
1004
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001005tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1006 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1007 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1008 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1009 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1010 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1011 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1012 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1013 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1014 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1015 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001016 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1017 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001018
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001019tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1020 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001021 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001022 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1023 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1024 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1025
1026tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1027 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1028 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1029 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1030 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010323.3. Debugging
1033--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001034
1035debug
1036 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1037 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1038 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1039 system startup.
1040
1041quiet
1042 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1043 line argument "-q".
1044
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001045
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010463.4. Userlists
1047--------------
1048It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1049http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1050it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1051
1052userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001053 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001054 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1055
1056group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001057 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001058 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1059 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1060
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001061user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1062 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001063 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1064 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001065 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1066 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001067 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001068 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001069
1070
1071 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001072 userlist L1
1073 group G1 users tiger,scott
1074 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001075
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001076 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1077 user scott insecure-password elgato
1078 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001079
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001080 userlist L2
1081 group G1
1082 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001083
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001084 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1085 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1086 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001087
1088 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001090
10913.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001092----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001093It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1094haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1095pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1096identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1097or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1098Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1099known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1100the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1101process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1102during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1103tables.
1104
1105peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001106 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001107 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1108
1109peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1110 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1111 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1112 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1113 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1114 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1115 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1116
1117 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1118 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1119
1120 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1121 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1122 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1123 across all peers.
1124
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001125 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1126 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1127 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1128
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001129 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001130 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001131 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1132 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1133 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001134
1135 backend mybackend
1136 mode tcp
1137 balance roundrobin
1138 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1139 stick on src
1140
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001141 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1142 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001143
1144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011454. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001146----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001147
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001148Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1149 - defaults <name>
1150 - frontend <name>
1151 - backend <name>
1152 - listen <name>
1153
1154A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1155its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1156section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001157section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001158
1159A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1160connections.
1161
1162A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1163to forward incoming connections.
1164
1165A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1166parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001168All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1169'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1170case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1171
1172Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1173logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1174proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1175However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1176name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1177
1178Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1179and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001180bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001181protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1182modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1183arbitrary criteria.
1184
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001185In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1186a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1187the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1188
1189 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1190 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1191 between responses and new requests.
1192
1193 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1194 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1195 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1196 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1197
1198 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1199 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1200 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1201
1202 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1203 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1204 client-facing connection remains open.
1205
1206 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1207 after the end of the response.
1208
1209The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1210frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1211following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1212weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1213
1214 Backend mode
1215
1216 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1217 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1218 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1219 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1220 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1221 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1222 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1223 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1224 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1225 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1226 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1227
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001228
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012304.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1231--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001233The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1234limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1235they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1236limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001237marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001238option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001239and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1240with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1241specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001242
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001243
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001244 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1245------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1246acl - X X X
1247appsession - - X X
1248backlog X X X -
1249balance X - X X
1250bind - X X -
1251bind-process X X X X
1252block - X X X
1253capture cookie - X X -
1254capture request header - X X -
1255capture response header - X X -
1256clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001257compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001258contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1259cookie X - X X
1260default-server X - X X
1261default_backend X X X -
1262description - X X X
1263disabled X X X X
1264dispatch - - X X
1265enabled X X X X
1266errorfile X X X X
1267errorloc X X X X
1268errorloc302 X X X X
1269-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1270errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001271force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001272fullconn X - X X
1273grace X X X X
1274hash-type X - X X
1275http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001276http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001277http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001278http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001279http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001280http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001281id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001282ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001283log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001284max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001285maxconn X X X -
1286mode X X X X
1287monitor fail - X X -
1288monitor-net X X X -
1289monitor-uri X X X -
1290option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1291option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1292option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1293option allbackups (*) X - X X
1294option checkcache (*) X - X X
1295option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1296option contstats (*) X X X -
1297option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1298option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1299option forceclose (*) X X X X
1300-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1301option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001302option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001303option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001304option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001305option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001306option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001307option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1308option httpchk X - X X
1309option httpclose (*) X X X X
1310option httplog X X X X
1311option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001312option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001313option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001314option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1315option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1316option logasap (*) X X X -
1317option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001318option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001319option nolinger (*) X X X X
1320option originalto X X X X
1321option persist (*) X - X X
1322option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001323option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001324option smtpchk X - X X
1325option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1326option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1327option splice-request (*) X X X X
1328option splice-response (*) X X X X
1329option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1330option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1331-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001332option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001333option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1334option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1335option tcpka X X X X
1336option tcplog X X X X
1337option transparent (*) X - X X
1338persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1339rate-limit sessions X X X -
1340redirect - X X X
1341redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1342redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1343reqadd - X X X
1344reqallow - X X X
1345reqdel - X X X
1346reqdeny - X X X
1347reqiallow - X X X
1348reqidel - X X X
1349reqideny - X X X
1350reqipass - X X X
1351reqirep - X X X
1352reqisetbe - X X X
1353reqitarpit - X X X
1354reqpass - X X X
1355reqrep - X X X
1356-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1357reqsetbe - X X X
1358reqtarpit - X X X
1359retries X - X X
1360rspadd - X X X
1361rspdel - X X X
1362rspdeny - X X X
1363rspidel - X X X
1364rspideny - X X X
1365rspirep - X X X
1366rsprep - X X X
1367server - - X X
1368source X - X X
1369srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001370stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001371stats auth X - X X
1372stats enable X - X X
1373stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001374stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001375stats realm X - X X
1376stats refresh X - X X
1377stats scope X - X X
1378stats show-desc X - X X
1379stats show-legends X - X X
1380stats show-node X - X X
1381stats uri X - X X
1382-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1383stick match - - X X
1384stick on - - X X
1385stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001386stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001387stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001388tcp-check connect - - X X
1389tcp-check expect - - X X
1390tcp-check send - - X X
1391tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001392tcp-request connection - X X -
1393tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001394tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001395tcp-response content - - X X
1396tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001397timeout check X - X X
1398timeout client X X X -
1399timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1400timeout connect X - X X
1401timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1402timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1403timeout http-request X X X X
1404timeout queue X - X X
1405timeout server X - X X
1406timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1407timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001408timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001409transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001410unique-id-format X X X -
1411unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001413use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001414------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1415 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014184.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1419---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420
1421This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1422
1423
1424acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1425 Declare or complete an access list.
1426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1427 no | yes | yes | yes
1428 Example:
1429 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1430 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1431 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001433 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001434
1435
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001436appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1437 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001438 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1440 no | no | yes | yes
1441 Arguments :
1442 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1443 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1444
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001445 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001446 checked in each cookie value.
1447
1448 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1449 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1450 milliseconds.
1451
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001452 request-learn
1453 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1454 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1455 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1456 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1457 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1458 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1459
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001460 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1461 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1462 data following this prefix.
1463
1464 Example :
1465 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1466
1467 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1468 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1469
1470 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1471 2 modes are currently supported :
1472 - path-parameters :
1473 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1474 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1475 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1476 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1477 - query-string :
1478 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1479 query string.
1480
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001481 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1482 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1483 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1484 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001485 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1486 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1487 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001488 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1489 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1490
1491 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1492
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001493 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1494 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1495 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1496
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001497 Example :
1498 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1499
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001500 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1501 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001502
1503
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001504backlog <conns>
1505 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1507 yes | yes | yes | no
1508 Arguments :
1509 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1510 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001511 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001512
1513 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1514 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1515 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1516 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1517 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1518 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1519 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1520 backlog parameter.
1521
1522 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1523 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1524 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1525
1526 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1527
1528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001529balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001530balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001531 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1533 yes | no | yes | yes
1534 Arguments :
1535 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1536 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1537 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1538 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1539
1540 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1541 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1542 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1543 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001544 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001545 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001546 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1547 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1548 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1549 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1550 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1551 it, so that you don't worry.
1552
1553 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1554 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1555 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1556 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1557 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1558 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1559 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1560 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001561
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001562 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1563 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1564 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1565 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1566 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1567 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1568 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1569 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1570
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001571 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001572 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001573 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1574 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001575 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001576 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1577 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1578 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1579 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1580 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001581 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1582 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1583 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1584 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1585 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1586 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001588 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1589 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1590 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1591 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1592 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1593 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1594 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1595 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001596 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001597 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001598 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1599 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1600 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001601
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001602 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1603 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1604 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1605 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1606 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1607 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1608 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1609 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1610 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1611 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1612 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1613 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001614
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001615 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001616 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1617 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1618 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1619 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1620 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1621 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1622 URIs start with a leading "/".
1623
1624 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1625 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1626 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1627 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001629 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001630 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1631
1632 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001633 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1634 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001635 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1636 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1637 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1638 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001639 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001640 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1641 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001642
1643 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1644 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1645 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1646 server will receive the request.
1647
1648 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1649 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1650 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1651 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1652 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001653 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1654 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1655 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001656
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001657 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1658 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1659 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1660 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1661 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001662
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001663 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001664 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1665 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1666 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1667
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001668 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1669 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1670 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1671
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001672 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001673 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001674 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1675 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1676 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1677 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1678 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1679 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001680 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001681 used instead.
1682
1683 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1684 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1685 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1686 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1687
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001688 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1689 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1690 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1691
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001692 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001695 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1696 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001697
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001698 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1699 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1700 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001701
1702 Examples :
1703 balance roundrobin
1704 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001705 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001706 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1707 balance hdr(host)
1708 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001709
1710 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1711 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1712
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001713 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001714 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1715 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1716 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1717 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1718
1719 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1720 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1721 defaults to 16 kB.
1722
1723 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1724 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1725
1726 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1727 Round Robin.
1728
1729 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1730 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1731 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1732 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1733
1734 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1735
1736 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001737 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001738 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1739 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1740 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001741
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001742 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1743 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001744
1745
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001746bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1747bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1750 no | yes | yes | no
1751 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001752 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1753 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1754 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1755 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001756 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001757 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1758 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1759 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1760 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1761 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1762 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1763 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001764 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1765 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1766 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001767 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1768 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1769 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1770 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001771
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001772 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1773 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001774 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1775 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1776 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001777 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1778 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1779 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1780 the range.
1781
1782 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1783 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1784 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1785 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1786 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1787 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1788 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001789 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001790 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001791
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001792 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1793 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1794 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1795 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1796 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1797 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1798 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1799 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1800
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001801 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1802 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1803 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1804 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001805
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1807 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1808 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1809 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1810 in a frontend.
1811
1812 Example :
1813 listen http_proxy
1814 bind :80,:443
1815 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001816 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001817
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001818 listen http_https_proxy
1819 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001820 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001821
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001822 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1823 bind ipv6@:80
1824 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1825 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1826
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001827 listen external_bind_app1
1828 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1829
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001830 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001831 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832
1833
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001834bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001835 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1837 yes | yes | yes | yes
1838 Arguments :
1839 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1840 may be used to override a default value.
1841
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001842 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001843 option may be combined with other numbers.
1844
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001845 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001846 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1847 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1848 missing from all processes.
1849
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001850 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001851 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001852 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1853 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1854 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1855 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001856
1857 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1858 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1859 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1860 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1861 and 'even' instances.
1862
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001863 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1864 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1865 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1866 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001867
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001868 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1869 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1870
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001871 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1872 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1873
1874 Example :
1875 listen app_ip1
1876 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001877 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001878
1879 listen app_ip2
1880 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001881 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001882
1883 listen management
1884 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001885 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001886
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001887 listen management
1888 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1889 bind-process 1-4
1890
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001891 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001892
1893
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894block { if | unless } <condition>
1895 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1897 no | yes | yes | yes
1898
1899 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1900 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001901 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001902 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001903 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1904 "block" statements per instance.
1905
1906 Example:
1907 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1908 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1909 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1910 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001912 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001913
1914
1915capture cookie <name> len <length>
1916 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1918 no | yes | yes | no
1919 Arguments :
1920 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1921 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1922 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1923 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1924 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1925
1926 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1927 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1928 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1929 right if it exceeds <length>.
1930
1931 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1932 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1933 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1934 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1935
1936 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1937 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1938 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1939
1940 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1941 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1942 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001943 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1944 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1945 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001946
1947 Example:
1948 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1949
1950 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001951 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001952
1953
1954capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001955 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1957 no | yes | yes | no
1958 Arguments :
1959 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001960 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001961 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1962 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1963 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1964
1965 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1966 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1967 it exceeds <length>.
1968
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001969 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001970 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1971 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001972 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1973 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1974 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1975 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001976 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001977 environments to find where the request came from.
1978
1979 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1980 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1981 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1982 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001983
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001984 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1985 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1986 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1987 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1988 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001989
1990 Example:
1991 capture request header Host len 15
1992 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1993 capture request header Referrer len 15
1994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001995 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001996 about logging.
1997
1998
1999capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002000 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2002 no | yes | yes | no
2003 Arguments :
2004 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002005 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002006 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2007 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2008 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2009
2010 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2011 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2012 it exceeds <length>.
2013
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002014 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002015 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2016 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2017 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002018 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2019 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2020 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2021 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002022
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002023 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2024 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2025 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2026 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2027 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002028
2029 Example:
2030 capture response header Content-length len 9
2031 capture response header Location len 15
2032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002033 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002034 about logging.
2035
2036
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002037clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2040 yes | yes | yes | no
2041 Arguments :
2042 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2043 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2044 as explained at the top of this document.
2045
2046 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2047 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2048 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2049 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2050 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2051 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2052 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2053 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002054 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002055 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2056 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2057
2058 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2059 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2060 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2061 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2062 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2063 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2064
2065 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2066 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2067
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002068 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2069 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002071compression algo <algorithm> ...
2072compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002073compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002074 Enable HTTP compression.
2075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2076 yes | yes | yes | yes
2077 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002078 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2079 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2080 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2081
2082 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002083 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002084 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2085 data.
2086
2087 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2088 support for zlib was built in.
2089
2090 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2091 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2092 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2093 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2094 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2095 in.
2096
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002097 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002098 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002099 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2100 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2101 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2102 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2103 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002104
2105 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2106 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2107 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2108 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2109 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002110 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2111 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2112 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2113 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2114 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2115 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002116
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002117 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002118 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2119 "Accept-Encoding" header
2120 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002121 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002122 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2123 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002124 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2125 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2126 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2127 "multipart"
2128 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2129 header
2130 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2131 and later
2132 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2133 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002134
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002135 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2136 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002137
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002138 Examples :
2139 compression algo gzip
2140 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002141
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002142contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002143 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2145 yes | no | yes | yes
2146 Arguments :
2147 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2148 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2149 as explained at the top of this document.
2150
2151 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002152 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002153 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002154 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2155 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2156 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2157 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2158
2159 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2160 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2161 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2162 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2163 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2164 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2165
2166 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2167 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2168 instead.
2169
2170 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2171 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2172
2173
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002174cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002175 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2176 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002177 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2179 yes | no | yes | yes
2180 Arguments :
2181 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2182 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2183 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2184 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2185 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2186 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2187 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2188 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2189 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2190
2191 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2192 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2193 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2194 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2195 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2196 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2197 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2198 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2199 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2200 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2201 "insert" and "prefix".
2202
2203 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002204 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002205
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002206 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002207 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2208 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2209 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2210 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2211 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2212 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2213 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2214 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2215 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2216 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002217
2218 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2219 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2220 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2221 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2222 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2223 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2224 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2225 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2226 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2227 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002228 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2229 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2230 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002231
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002232 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2233 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2234 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002235 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2236 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2237 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2238 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002239 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2240 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2241 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242
2243 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2244 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2245 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2246 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2247 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2248 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2249 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2250 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2251 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2252
2253 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2254 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2255 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2256 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2257 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2258 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2259 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2260 persistence cookie in the cache.
2261 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2262
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002263 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2264 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2265 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2266 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2267 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2268 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2269 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2270 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2271 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2272 they logout.
2273
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002274 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2275 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2276 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2277 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2278
2279 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2280 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2281 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2282 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2283 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2284 this attribute.
2285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002286 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002287 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002288 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2289 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2290 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2291 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2292 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2293 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002294
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002295 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2296 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2297 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2298 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2299 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2300 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2301 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2302 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2303 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2304 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2305 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2306 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2307 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2308 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2309 the site.
2310
2311 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2312 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2313 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2314 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2315 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2316 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2317 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2318 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2319 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2320 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2321 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2322 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2323 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2324 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2325 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2326 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2327
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002328 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2329 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2330 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2331 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002332
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333 Examples :
2334 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2335 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2336 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002337 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002338
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002339 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002340 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002341
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002343default-server [param*]
2344 Change default options for a server in a backend
2345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2346 yes | no | yes | yes
2347 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002348 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2349 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2350 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2351 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002352
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002353 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002354 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2355
2356 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002357
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002358
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002359default_backend <backend>
2360 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2362 yes | yes | yes | no
2363 Arguments :
2364 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2365
2366 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2367 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2368 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2369 will catch all undetermined requests.
2370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002371 Example :
2372
2373 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2374 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2375 default_backend dynamic
2376
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002377 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002380description <string>
2381 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2383 no | yes | yes | yes
2384 Arguments : string
2385
2386 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2387 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2388 it describes.
2389 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2390
2391
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002392disabled
2393 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2395 yes | yes | yes | yes
2396 Arguments : none
2397
2398 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2399 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2400 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2401 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2402 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2403 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2404 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2405
2406 See also : "enabled"
2407
2408
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002409dispatch <address>:<port>
2410 Set a default server address
2411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2412 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002413 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002414
2415 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2416 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2417 during start-up.
2418
2419 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2420 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2421 possible with normal servers.
2422
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002423 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002424 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2425 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2426 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2427 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2428
2429 See also : "server"
2430
2431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002432enabled
2433 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2435 yes | yes | yes | yes
2436 Arguments : none
2437
2438 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2439 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2440
2441 See also : "disabled"
2442
2443
2444errorfile <code> <file>
2445 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2447 yes | yes | yes | yes
2448 Arguments :
2449 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002450 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002451
2452 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002453 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002454 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002455 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2456 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457
2458 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2459 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2460 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2461
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002462 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002464 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2465 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2466 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2467 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2468
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002469 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2470 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2471 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2472 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2473 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2474 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002476 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2477 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2478 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002479 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2481
2482 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2483
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002484 Example :
2485 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2486 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2487 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2488
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002489
2490errorloc <code> <url>
2491errorloc302 <code> <url>
2492 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2494 yes | yes | yes | yes
2495 Arguments :
2496 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002497 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002498
2499 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2500 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2501 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2502 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2503 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2504
2505 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2506 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2507 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2508
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002509 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002511 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2512 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2513 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2514 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2515 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2516 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2517 request.
2518
2519 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2520
2521
2522errorloc303 <code> <url>
2523 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2525 yes | yes | yes | yes
2526 Arguments :
2527 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2528 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2529
2530 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2531 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2532 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2533 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2534 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2535
2536 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2537 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2538 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2539
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002540 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2541
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002542 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2543 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2544 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2545 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002546 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002547
2548 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2549
2550
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002551force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2552 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2553 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2554 no | yes | yes | yes
2555
2556 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2557 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2558 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2559 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2560 marked down for maintenance operations.
2561
2562 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2563 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2564 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2565 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2566 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2567 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2568 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2569 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2570 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2571
2572 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2573 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2574 is used.
2575
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002576 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002577 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002578
2579
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002580fullconn <conns>
2581 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2583 yes | no | yes | yes
2584 Arguments :
2585 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2586 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2587
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002588 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002589 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002590 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002591 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2592 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2593 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2594 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2595 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002596 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002597
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002598 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2599 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002600 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2601 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2602 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002603
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002604 Example :
2605 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2606 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2607 # connections.
2608 backend dynamic
2609 fullconn 10000
2610 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2611 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2612
2613 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2614
2615
2616grace <time>
2617 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002619 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002620 Arguments :
2621 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2622 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2623 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2624
2625 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2626 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002627 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002628 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2629
2630 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2631 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2632 simplify it.
2633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002635hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002636 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2638 yes | no | yes | yes
2639 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002640 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2641 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002642
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002643 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2644 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2645 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2646 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2647 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2648 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2649 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2650 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2651 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2652 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002653
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002654 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2655 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2656 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2657 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2658 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2659 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2660 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2661 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2662 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2663 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2664 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2665 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2666 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002667 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2668 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002669
2670 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2671
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002672 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002673 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2674 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2675 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002676 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2677 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2678 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002679
2680 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2681 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002682 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2683 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2684 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2685 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2686
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002687 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2688 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2689 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2690 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2691 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2692 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2693 parameter.
2694
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002695 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2696
2697 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2698 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2699 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2700 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2701 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2702 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2703 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2704 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2705 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2706 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2707 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2708 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002709
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002710 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2711 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2712 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002713
2714 See also : "balance", "server"
2715
2716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002717http-check disable-on-404
2718 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002720 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721 Arguments : none
2722
2723 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2724 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2725 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2726 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2727 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2728 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2729 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2730 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002731 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2732 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2733 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2734
2735 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2736
2737
2738http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002739 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002741 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002742 Arguments :
2743 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2744 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002745 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002746 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2747 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2748 details on the supported keywords.
2749
2750 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2751 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2752 with the usual backslash ('\').
2753
2754 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2755 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2756 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2757 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2758 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2759
2760 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002761 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002762 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2763 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2764 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2765
2766 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002767 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002768 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2769 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2770 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2771 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2772
2773 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002774 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002775 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2776 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2777 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2778 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2779 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2780 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2781 trace).
2782
2783 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002784 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002785 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2786 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2787 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2788 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2789 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2790 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2791
2792 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2793 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2794 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2795 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2796 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2797 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2798 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2799 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2800
2801 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2802 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2803
2804 Examples :
2805 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002806 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002807
2808 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002809 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002810
2811 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002812 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002813
2814 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002815 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002817 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002818
2819
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002820http-check send-state
2821 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2823 yes | no | yes | yes
2824 Arguments : none
2825
2826 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2827 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2828 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2829 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2830 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2831
2832 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2833 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2834 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2835 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2836 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2837 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2838 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2839 checked in multiple backends.
2840
2841 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2842 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2843
2844 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2845 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2846 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2847 one fails.
2848
2849 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2850 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2851 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2852
2853 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2854 server's queue.
2855
2856 Example of a header received by the application server :
2857 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2858 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2859
2860 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2861
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002862http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002863 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002864 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002865 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2866 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2867 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2868 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2869 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2870 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002871 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002872 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2873
2874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2875 no | yes | yes | yes
2876
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002877 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2878 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2879 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2880 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2881 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002882
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002883 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2884 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2885 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2886
2887 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2888 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2889 are evaluated.
2890
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002891 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2892 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2893 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2894 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2895 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2896 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2897 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2898 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2899 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002900 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002901 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2902
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002903 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2904 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2905 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2906 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2907 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2908
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002909 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2910 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2911 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002912 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2913 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002914
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002915 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2916 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2917 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2918 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2919 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2920 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2921 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2922 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2923
2924 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2925 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2926 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2927 external users.
2928
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002929 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2930 <name>.
2931
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002932 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2933 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2934 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2935 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2936 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2937 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2938 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2939 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2940
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002941 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2942 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2943 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2944 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2945 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2946 another equipment.
2947
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002948 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2949 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2950 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2951 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2952 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2953 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2954 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2955 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2956
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002957 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2958 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2959 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2960 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2961 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2962 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2963 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2964 admin privileges.
2965
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002966 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2967 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2968 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2969 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
2970 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2971 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
2972 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
2973 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2974
2975 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2976 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2977 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2978 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2979 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
2980 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2981
2982 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2983 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2984 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2985 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2986 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
2987 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2988
2989 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2990 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2991 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
2992 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
2993 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
2994 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2995 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
2996 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
2997 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2998
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002999 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3000
3001 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3002 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3003 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3004 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003005
3006 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003007 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3008 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3009 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003010
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003011 http-request allow if nagios
3012 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3013 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3014 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003015
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003016 Example:
3017 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003018 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003019
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003020 Example:
3021 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3022 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3023 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3024 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3025 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3026 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3027 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3028 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3029 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3030
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003031 Example:
3032 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3033 acl add path /addacl
3034 acl del path /delacl
3035
3036 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3037
3038 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3039 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3040
3041 Example:
3042 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3043 acl setmap path /setmap
3044 acl delmap path /delmap
3045
3046 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3047
3048 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3049 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3050
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003051 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3052 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003053
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003054http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003055 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003056 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3057 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3058 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3059 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3060 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3061 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003062 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003063 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3064
3065 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3066 no | yes | yes | yes
3067
3068 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3069 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3070 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3071 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3072 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3073 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3074
3075 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3076 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3077 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3078 current section.
3079
3080 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3081 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3082 rules are evaluated.
3083
3084 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3085 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3086 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3087 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3088 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3089 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3090 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3091
3092 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3093 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3094 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3095 external users.
3096
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003097 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3098 <name>.
3099
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003100 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3101 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3102 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3103 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3104 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3105 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3106 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3107 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3108
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003109 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3110 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3111 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3112 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3113 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3114 another equipment.
3115
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003116 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3117 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3118 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3119 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3120 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3121 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3122 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3123 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3124
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003125 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3126 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3127 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3128 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3129 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3130 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3131 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3132 admin privileges.
3133
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003134 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3135 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3136 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3137 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3138 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3139 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3140 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3141 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3142
3143 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3144 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3145 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3146 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3147 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3148 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3149
3150 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3151 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3152 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3153 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3154 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3155 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3156
3157 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3158 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3159 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3160 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3161 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3162 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3163 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3164 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3165 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3166
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003167 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3168
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003169 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003170 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3171 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3172 rules.
3173
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003174 Example:
3175 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3176
3177 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3178
3179 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3180 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3181
3182 Example:
3183 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3184
3185 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3186
3187 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3188 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3189
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003190 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3191 ACL usage.
3192
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003193
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003194http-send-name-header [<header>]
3195 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3196
3197 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3198 yes | no | yes | yes
3199
3200 Arguments :
3201
3202 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3203
3204 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3205 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3206 is added with the header string proved.
3207
3208 See also : "server"
3209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003210id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003211 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3213 no | yes | yes | yes
3214 Arguments : none
3215
3216 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3217 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3218 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003219
3220
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003221ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3222 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3223 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3224 no | yes | yes | yes
3225
3226 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3227 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3228 and running).
3229
3230 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3231 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3232 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003233 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003234 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3235
3236 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3237 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3238
3239 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3240 "unless" condition is met.
3241
3242 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3243
3244
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003245log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003246log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003247no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003248 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3250 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003251
3252 Prefix :
3253 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3254 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3255 prefix does not allow arguments.
3256
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003257 Arguments :
3258 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3259 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3260 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3261 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3262 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3263 parameter.
3264
3265 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3266 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3267
3268 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3269 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3270 standard syslog port).
3271
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003272 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3273 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3274 standard syslog port).
3275
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003276 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3277 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3278 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3279 appropriately writeable).
3280
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003281 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3282 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3283 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3284 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3285
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003286 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3287
3288 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3289 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3290 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3291
3292 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3293 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3294 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003295 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3296 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3297 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3298 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3299 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003300
3301 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3302
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003303 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3304 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3305 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003306
3307 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3308 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3309 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3310 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3311
3312 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3313 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003314
3315 Example :
3316 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003317 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3318 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003319 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3320
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003321
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003322log-format <string>
3323 Allows you to custom a log line.
3324
3325 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3326
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003327
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003328max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3329 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3331 yes | no | yes | yes
3332
3333 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3334 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3335 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3336 servers.
3337
3338 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3339 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3340 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3341 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3342 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3343 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3344 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3345 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3346 picking a different server.
3347
3348 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3349 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3350 even if they have to be queued.
3351
3352 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3353 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3354
3355
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003356maxconn <conns>
3357 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3359 yes | yes | yes | no
3360 Arguments :
3361 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3362 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3363 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3364 closes.
3365
3366 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3367 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3368 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3369 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3370 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3371 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3372 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3373 properly tuned.
3374
3375 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3376 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3377 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3378
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003379 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3380
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003381 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3382
3383
3384mode { tcp|http|health }
3385 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3387 yes | yes | yes | yes
3388 Arguments :
3389 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3390 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3391 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3392 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3393
3394 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3395 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3396 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3397 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3398 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3399
3400 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003401 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3402 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3403 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3404 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3405 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3406 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3407 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003408
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003409 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3410 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3411 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003412
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003413 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003414 defaults http_instances
3415 mode http
3416
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003417 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003418
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003420monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003421 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3423 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003424 Arguments :
3425 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3426 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003427 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003428 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3429 backend and its backup.
3430
3431 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3432 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3433 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3434 servers in a list of backends.
3435
3436 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3437 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3438 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3439 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3440 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3441 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3442 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003443 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3444 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003445
3446 Example:
3447 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003448 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3450 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3451 monitor-uri /site_alive
3452 monitor fail if site_dead
3453
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003454 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003455
3456
3457monitor-net <source>
3458 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3460 yes | yes | yes | no
3461 Arguments :
3462 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3463 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3464 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3465 followed by a mask.
3466
3467 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3468 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003469 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003470 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3471
3472 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3473 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3474 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3475 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003476 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3477 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3478 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003479
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003480 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3481 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3482 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3483 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3484 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3485 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003486
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003487 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3488 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003489
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003490 Example :
3491 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3492 frontend www
3493 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3494
3495 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3496
3497
3498monitor-uri <uri>
3499 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3501 yes | yes | yes | no
3502 Arguments :
3503 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3504 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3505
3506 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3507 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3508 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3509 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3510 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3511 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3512 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3513 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3514
3515 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3516 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3517 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3518 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3519 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3520 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3521
3522 Example :
3523 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3524 frontend www
3525 mode http
3526 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3527
3528 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3529
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003531option abortonclose
3532no option abortonclose
3533 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 yes | no | yes | yes
3536 Arguments : none
3537
3538 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3539 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3540 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3541 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003542 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003543 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3544 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3545 encountered while delivering the response.
3546
3547 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3548 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3549 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3550 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3551 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3552 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003553 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003554 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003555 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003556 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3557 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3558 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3559
3560 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3561 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3562 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3563 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3564 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3565 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3566 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3567 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003568 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003569
3570 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3571 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3572
3573 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3574
3575
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003576option accept-invalid-http-request
3577no option accept-invalid-http-request
3578 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 yes | yes | yes | no
3581 Arguments : none
3582
3583 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3584 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3585 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3586 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3587 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3588 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3589 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3590 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003591 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3592 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3593 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3594 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3595 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3596 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003597
3598 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3599 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3600 been confirmed.
3601
3602 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3603 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003604 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3605 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003606 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3607
3608 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3609 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3610
3611 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3612 stats socket.
3613
3614
3615option accept-invalid-http-response
3616no option accept-invalid-http-response
3617 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3619 yes | no | yes | yes
3620 Arguments : none
3621
3622 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3623 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3624 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3625 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3626 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3627 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3628 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3629 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3630 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3631
3632 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3633 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3634 been confirmed.
3635
3636 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3637 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3638 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3639 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3640
3641 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3642 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3643
3644 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3645 stats socket.
3646
3647
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003648option allbackups
3649no option allbackups
3650 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3652 yes | no | yes | yes
3653 Arguments : none
3654
3655 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3656 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3657 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3658 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3659 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3660 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3661 order between the backup servers anymore.
3662
3663 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3664 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3665
3666 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3667 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3668
3669
3670option checkcache
3671no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003672 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3674 yes | no | yes | yes
3675 Arguments : none
3676
3677 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3678 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003679 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003680 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3681 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003682 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003683
3684 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003685 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003686 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003687 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3688 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003689 to the client are :
3690 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003691 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003692 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003693 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3694 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3695 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3696 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3697 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3698 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3699 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3700 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3701 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3702 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3703 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3704
3705 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003706 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003707 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003708 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003709 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3710
3711 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3712 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003713 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003714 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3715
3716 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3717 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3718
3719
3720option clitcpka
3721no option clitcpka
3722 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3724 yes | yes | yes | no
3725 Arguments : none
3726
3727 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3728 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3729 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3730 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3731
3732 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3733 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3734 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3735 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3736
3737 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3738 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3739 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3740 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3741 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3742
3743 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3744
3745 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3746 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3747 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3748
3749 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3750 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3751
3752 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3753
3754
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003755option contstats
3756 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3758 yes | yes | yes | no
3759 Arguments : none
3760
3761 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3762 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3763 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3764 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3765 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3766 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3767 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3768
3769
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003770option dontlog-normal
3771no option dontlog-normal
3772 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 yes | yes | yes | no
3775 Arguments : none
3776
3777 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3778 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3779 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3780 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3781 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3782 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3783 logged.
3784
3785 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3786 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3787 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003789 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003790 logging.
3791
3792
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003793option dontlognull
3794no option dontlognull
3795 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3797 yes | yes | yes | no
3798 Arguments : none
3799
3800 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3801 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3802 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3803 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3804 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3805 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3806 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3807
3808 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3809 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3810 would not be logged.
3811
3812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003815 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003816
3817
3818option forceclose
3819no option forceclose
3820 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003822 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003823 Arguments : none
3824
3825 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3826 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3827 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3828 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3829 global session times in the logs.
3830
3831 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003832 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003833 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003834
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003835 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3836 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3837 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3838
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003839 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3840 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003841
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3844
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003845 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003846
3847
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003848option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003849 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3851 yes | yes | yes | yes
3852 Arguments :
3853 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3854 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003855 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003856 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003857
3858 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3859 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3860 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3861 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3862 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3863 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3864 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003865 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3866 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3867 possible that the client has already brought one.
3868
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003869 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003870 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003871 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3872 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003873 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3874 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003875
3876 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3877 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3878 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3879 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3880 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3881 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3882 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3883
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003884 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3885 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3886 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3887 are under the control of the end-user.
3888
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003889 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003890 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3891 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003892 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3893 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3894 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003895
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003896 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003897 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3898 frontend www
3899 mode http
3900 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3901
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003902 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3903 backend www
3904 mode http
3905 option forwardfor header X-Client
3906
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003907 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003908 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003909
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003910
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003911option http-keep-alive
3912no option http-keep-alive
3913 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3915 yes | yes | yes | yes
3916 Arguments : none
3917
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003918 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3919 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3920 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3921 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3922 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3923 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3924 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3925
3926 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3927 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003928 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3929 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3930 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3931 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3932 situations where this option may be useful :
3933
3934 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3935 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3936
3937 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3938 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3939
3940 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3941 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3942 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3943 request.
3944
3945 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3946 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003947 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3948 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3949 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003950
3951 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3952 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3953
3954 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3955 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3956 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3957 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3958 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3959 not set.
3960
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003961 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3962 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003963 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003964 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003965
3966 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003967 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3968 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003969
3970
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003971option http-no-delay
3972no option http-no-delay
3973 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3975 yes | yes | yes | yes
3976 Arguments : none
3977
3978 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3979 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3980 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3981 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3982 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3983 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3984 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3985 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3986 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3987 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3988 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3989 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3990 affected.
3991
3992 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3993 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3994 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3995 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3996 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3997 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3998 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3999 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4000 latency environments.
4001
4002
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004003option http-pretend-keepalive
4004no option http-pretend-keepalive
4005 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4007 yes | yes | yes | yes
4008 Arguments : none
4009
4010 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4011 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4012 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4013 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4014 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4015 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4016 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4017 consider the response complete.
4018
4019 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4020 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4021 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4022 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4023 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4024 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4025
4026 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4027 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4028 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4029 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4030 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4031 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4032 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4033
4034 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4035 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004036 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004037 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4038 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004039
4040 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4041 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4042
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004043 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4044 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004045
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004046
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004047option http-server-close
4048no option http-server-close
4049 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4051 yes | yes | yes | yes
4052 Arguments : none
4053
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004054 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4055 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4056 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4057 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4058 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4059 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4060 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4061 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4062 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4063 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4064 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4065 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4066 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4067 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4068 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4069 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004070
4071 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4072 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4073 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4074 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004075 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4076 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004077
4078 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4079 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004080 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4081 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004082 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4083 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004084
4085 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4086 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4087
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004088 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004089 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4090 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004091
4092
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004093option http-tunnel
4094no option http-tunnel
4095 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4097 yes | yes | yes | yes
4098 Arguments : none
4099
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004100 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4101 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4102 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4103 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4104 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4105 "option http-tunnel".
4106
4107 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004108 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004109 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4110 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4111 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4112 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4113 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4114 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4115 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004116
4117 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4118 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4119
4120 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4121 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4122 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4123
4124
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004125option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004126no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004127 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4129 yes | yes | yes | no
4130 Arguments : none
4131
4132 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4133 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4134 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4135 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4136 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4137 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4138 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4139
4140 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4141 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4142 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4143 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4144 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4145 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4146 request along its whole life.
4147
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004148 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4149 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4150 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4151 front of an existing proxy.
4152
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004153 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4154
4155 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4156 http-server-close".
4157
4158
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004159option httpchk
4160option httpchk <uri>
4161option httpchk <method> <uri>
4162option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4163 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4165 yes | no | yes | yes
4166 Arguments :
4167 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4168 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4169 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4170 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4171 ones.
4172
4173 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4174 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4175 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4176
4177 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4178 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4179 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4180 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4181 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4182
4183 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4184 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4185 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4186 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4187 the lack of any response.
4188
4189 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4190
4191 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4192 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4193 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4194
4195 Examples :
4196 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4197 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4198 backend https_relay
4199 mode tcp
4200 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4201 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4202
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004203 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4204 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4205 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004206
4207
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004208option httpclose
4209no option httpclose
4210 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4212 yes | yes | yes | yes
4213 Arguments : none
4214
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004215 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4216 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4217 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4218 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004219 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004220 "option http-tunnel".
4221
4222 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4223 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4224 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4225 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4226 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4227 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4228 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4229 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004230
4231 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004232 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004233 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4234 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4235 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4236 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4237 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004238
4239 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4240 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004241 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4242 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004243 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4244 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004245
4246 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4247 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4248
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004249 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4250 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004251
4252
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004253option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004254 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4256 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004257 Arguments :
4258 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4259 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4260 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4261 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4262 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004263
4264 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4265 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4266 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4267 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4268 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4269 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4270 ports.
4271
4272 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4273
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004274 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4275 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4276 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4277 by default.
4278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004279 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004280
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004281
4282option http_proxy
4283no option http_proxy
4284 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4286 yes | yes | yes | yes
4287 Arguments : none
4288
4289 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4290 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4291 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4292 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4293 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4294
4295 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4296 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4297 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4298 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004299 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004300 be analyzed.
4301
4302 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4303 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4304
4305 Example :
4306 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4307 backend direct_forward
4308 option httpclose
4309 option http_proxy
4310
4311 See also : "option httpclose"
4312
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004313
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004314option independent-streams
4315no option independent-streams
4316 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4318 yes | yes | yes | yes
4319 Arguments : none
4320
4321 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4322 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4323 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4324 receive data or not.
4325
4326 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4327 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4328 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4329 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4330 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4331 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4332 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4333 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4334 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4335 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4336 socket buffers.
4337
4338 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4339 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4340 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4341 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4342 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4343
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004344 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004345 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4346 deprecated.
4347
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004348 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004349
4350
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004351option ldap-check
4352 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4354 yes | no | yes | yes
4355 Arguments : none
4356
4357 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4358 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4359 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4360 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4361
4362 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4363 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4364
4365 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4366 configure it.
4367
4368 Example :
4369 option ldap-check
4370
4371 See also : "option httpchk"
4372
4373
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004374option log-health-checks
4375no option log-health-checks
4376 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4378 yes | no | yes | yes
4379 Arguments : none
4380
4381 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4382 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4383 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4384 of additional information is limited.
4385
4386 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4387 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4388
4389 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4390
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004391
4392option log-separate-errors
4393no option log-separate-errors
4394 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4396 yes | yes | yes | no
4397 Arguments : none
4398
4399 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4400 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4401 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4402 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4403 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4404 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4405 provides very important information.
4406
4407 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4408 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4409 error logs.
4410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004411 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004412 logging.
4413
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004414
4415option logasap
4416no option logasap
4417 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4419 yes | yes | yes | no
4420 Arguments : none
4421
4422 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4423 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4424 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4425 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4426 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4427 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4428 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004429 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004430 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4431 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4432
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004433 Examples :
4434 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4435 mode http
4436 option httplog
4437 option logasap
4438 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4439
4440 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4441 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4442 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4443 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004445 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004446 logging.
4447
4448
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004449option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4450 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4452 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004453 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004454 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4455 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004456
4457 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4458 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4459 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4460 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4461 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4462 in the MySQL table, like this :
4463
4464 USE mysql;
4465 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4466 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4467
4468 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4469 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4470 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4471 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4472 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4473 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4474 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4475 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4476 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4477
4478 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4479 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004480
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004481 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004482
4483 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4484 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4485 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4486 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4487 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4488 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4489
4490 See also: "option httpchk"
4491
4492
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004493option nolinger
4494no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004495 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004496 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4497 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004498 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004499
4500 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4501 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4502 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4503 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4504 connections.
4505
4506 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4507 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4508 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4509 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4510 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4511 this too.
4512
4513 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4514 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4515 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4516
4517 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4518 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4519 for servers.
4520
4521 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4522 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4523
4524
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004525option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4526 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4528 yes | yes | yes | yes
4529 Arguments :
4530 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4531 matching <network>
4532 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4533 header name.
4534
4535 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4536 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4537 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4538 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4539 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4540 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4541 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4542 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4543 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4544 possible that the client has already brought one.
4545
4546 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4547 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4548 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4549 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4550 header and requires different one.
4551
4552 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4553 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4554 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4555 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4556 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4557 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4558 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4559
4560 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4561 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4562 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4563 both are defined.
4564
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004565 Examples :
4566 # Original Destination address
4567 frontend www
4568 mode http
4569 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4570
4571 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4572 backend www
4573 mode http
4574 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4575
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004576 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4577 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004578
4579
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004580option persist
4581no option persist
4582 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4584 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004585 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004586
4587 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4588 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4589 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4590 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4591 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4592 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4593 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4594 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4595 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4596 redirected to another valid server.
4597
4598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4600
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004601 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004602
4603
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004604option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4605 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4607 yes | no | yes | yes
4608 Arguments :
4609 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4610 PostgreSQL server.
4611
4612 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4613 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4614 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4615 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4616
4617 See also: "option httpchk"
4618
4619
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004620option prefer-last-server
4621no option prefer-last-server
4622 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4623 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4624 yes | no | yes | yes
4625 Arguments : none
4626
4627 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4628 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4629 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4630 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4631 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4632 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4633 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4634 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4635 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004636 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4637 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4638 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4639 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4640 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4641 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4642 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004643
4644 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4645 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4646
4647 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4648
4649
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004650option redispatch
4651no option redispatch
4652 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4654 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004655 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004656
4657 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4658 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4659 be able to access the service anymore.
4660
4661 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4662 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4663
4664 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4665 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4666 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004668 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4669 "redisp" keywords.
4670
4671 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4672 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4673
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004674 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004675
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004676
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004677option redis-check
4678 Use redis health checks for server testing
4679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4680 yes | no | yes | yes
4681 Arguments : none
4682
4683 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4684 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4685 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4686 find the "+PONG" response message.
4687
4688 Example :
4689 option redis-check
4690
4691 See also : "option httpchk"
4692
4693
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004694option smtpchk
4695option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4696 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4698 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004699 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004700 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4701 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4702 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4703
4704 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4705 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4706 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4707
4708 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4709 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4710 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4711 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4712 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4713 dead server.
4714
4715 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4716 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4717 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4718 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4719
4720 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4721 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4722 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4723 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4724 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4725
4726 Example :
4727 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4728
4729 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004732option socket-stats
4733no option socket-stats
4734
4735 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4737 yes | yes | yes | no
4738
4739 Arguments : none
4740
4741
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004742option splice-auto
4743no option splice-auto
4744 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4746 yes | yes | yes | yes
4747 Arguments : none
4748
4749 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4750 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4751 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4752 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004753 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004754 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4755 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4756 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4757 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4758
4759 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4760 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4761 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4762 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4763 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4764 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4765 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4766 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4767 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4768 keyword.
4769
4770 Example :
4771 option splice-auto
4772
4773 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4774 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4775
4776 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4777 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4778
4779
4780option splice-request
4781no option splice-request
4782 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4784 yes | yes | yes | yes
4785 Arguments : none
4786
4787 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004788 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004789 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4790 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4791 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4792 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4793
4794 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4795
4796 Example :
4797 option splice-request
4798
4799 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4800 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4801
4802 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4803 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4804
4805
4806option splice-response
4807no option splice-response
4808 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4810 yes | yes | yes | yes
4811 Arguments : none
4812
4813 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004814 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004815 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4816 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4817 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4818 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4819
4820 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4821
4822 Example :
4823 option splice-response
4824
4825 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4826 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4827
4828 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4829 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4830
4831
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004832option srvtcpka
4833no option srvtcpka
4834 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4836 yes | no | yes | yes
4837 Arguments : none
4838
4839 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4840 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4841 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4842 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4843
4844 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4845 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4846 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4847 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4848
4849 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4850 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4851 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4852 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4853 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4854
4855 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4856
4857 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4858 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4859 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4860
4861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4863
4864 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4865
4866
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004867option ssl-hello-chk
4868 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4870 yes | no | yes | yes
4871 Arguments : none
4872
4873 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4874 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4875 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4876 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4877 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4878 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4879 hello message.
4880
4881 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4882 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4883 messages, which is appreciable.
4884
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004885 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4886 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4887 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004888
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004889 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4890
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004891
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004892option tcp-check
4893 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4895 yes | no | yes | yes
4896
4897 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4898 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4899
4900 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4901 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4902 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4903
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004904 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004905 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4906 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4907 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4908 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4909 only.
4910
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004911 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004912 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4913 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4914 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4915 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4916
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004917 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004918 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4919 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004920 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004921 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4922 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4923 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4924 the respective protocols.
4925 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4926 analysed.
4927
4928 Examples :
4929 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4930 option tcp-check
4931 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4932
4933 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4934 option tcp-check
4935 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4936
4937 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4938 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004939 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004940 option tcp-check
4941 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4942 tcp-check expect +PONG
4943 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4944 tcp-check expect string role:master
4945 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4946 tcp-check expect string +OK
4947
4948 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4949 (send many headers before analyzing)
4950 option tcp-check
4951 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4952 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4953 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4954 tcp-check send \r\n
4955 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4956
4957
4958 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4959
4960
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004961option tcp-smart-accept
4962no option tcp-smart-accept
4963 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4965 yes | yes | yes | no
4966 Arguments : none
4967
4968 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4969 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4970 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4971 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4972 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4973 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4974
4975 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4976 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4977 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4978 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4979
4980 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4981 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4982 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4983 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4984
4985 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4986 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4987 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4988
4989 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4990 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4991 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4992
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004993 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4994
4995
4996option tcp-smart-connect
4997no option tcp-smart-connect
4998 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5000 yes | no | yes | yes
5001 Arguments : none
5002
5003 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5004 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5005 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5006 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5007 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5008
5009 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5010 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5011 complex.
5012
5013 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5014 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5015 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5016
5017 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5018 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5019
5020 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5021
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005022
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005023option tcpka
5024 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5026 yes | yes | yes | yes
5027 Arguments : none
5028
5029 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5030 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5031 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5032 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5033
5034 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5035 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5036 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5037 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5038
5039 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5040 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5041 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5042 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5043 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5044
5045 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5046
5047 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5048 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5049 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5050 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5051 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5052 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5053 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5054 backends.
5055
5056 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5057
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005058
5059option tcplog
5060 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 yes | yes | yes | yes
5063 Arguments : none
5064
5065 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5066 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5067 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5068 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5069 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5070 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5071 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5072 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5073
5074 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005076 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005077
5078
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005079option transparent
5080no option transparent
5081 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005083 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005084 Arguments : none
5085
5086 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5087 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5088 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5089 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5090 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5091 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5092 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5093 appropriate server.
5094
5095 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5096 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5097
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005098 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005099 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005100
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005101
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005102persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005103persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005104 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5106 yes | no | yes | yes
5107 Arguments :
5108 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005109 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5110 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005111
5112 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5113 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5114 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5115 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5116 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5117 forwarded to this server.
5118
5119 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5120 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5121 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005122 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005123 a single "listen" section.
5124
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005125 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5126 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5127 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5128
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005129 Example :
5130 listen tse-farm
5131 bind :3389
5132 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5133 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5134 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5135 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5136 persist rdp-cookie
5137 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005138 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005139 balance rdp-cookie
5140 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5141 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5142
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005143 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5144 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005145
5146
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005147rate-limit sessions <rate>
5148 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5150 yes | yes | yes | no
5151 Arguments :
5152 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5153 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5154
5155 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5156 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5157 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5158 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5159 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5160 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5161
5162 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5163 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5164 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5165 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5166
5167 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5168 listen smtp
5169 mode tcp
5170 bind :25
5171 rate-limit sessions 10
5172 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5173
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005174 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5175 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5176 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005177
5178 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5179
5180
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005181redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5182redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5183redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005184 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5186 no | yes | yes | yes
5187
5188 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005189 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005190
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005191 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005192 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005193 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5194 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5195 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005196
5197 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5198 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5199 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5200 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5201 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005202 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5203 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5204 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5205 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005206
5207 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5208 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5209 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5210 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5211 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5212 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005213 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005214 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005215 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5216 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5217 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005218
5219 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005220 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5221 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5222 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5223 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5224 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5225 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5226 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5227 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005228
5229 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5230 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5231
5232 - "drop-query"
5233 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5234 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5235 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5236 with a location-type redirect.
5237
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005238 - "append-slash"
5239 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5240 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5241 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5242 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5243
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005244 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5245 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5246 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5247 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5248 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5249 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5250 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5251
5252 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5253 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5254 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5255 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5256 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5257 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5258 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005259
5260 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5261 acl clear dst_port 80
5262 acl secure dst_port 8080
5263 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005264 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005265 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005266 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5267
5268 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005269 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5270 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5271 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005272 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005273
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005274 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5275 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5276 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5277
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005278 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005279 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005280
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005281 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5282 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5283 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005285 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005286
5287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005288redisp (deprecated)
5289redispatch (deprecated)
5290 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5291 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5292 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005293 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005294
5295 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5296 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5297 be able to access the service anymore.
5298
5299 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5300 redistribute them to a working server.
5301
5302 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5303 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5304 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005306 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5307 "option redispatch" instead.
5308
5309 See also : "option redispatch"
5310
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005311
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005312reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005313 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5315 no | yes | yes | yes
5316 Arguments :
5317 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5318 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005319 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005320
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005321 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5322 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5323
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005324 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5325 the last header of an HTTP request.
5326
5327 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5328 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5329 responses.
5330
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005331 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5332 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5333 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5334
5335 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5336 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005337
5338
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005339reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5340reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005341 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5343 no | yes | yes | yes
5344 Arguments :
5345 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5346 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5347 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5348 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5349 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5350 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5351 ignores case.
5352
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005353 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5354 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5355
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005356 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5357 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5358 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5359 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005360 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005361
5362 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5363 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5364
5365 Example :
5366 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5367 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5368 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5369
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005370 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5371 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005372
5373
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005374reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5375reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005376 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5378 no | yes | yes | yes
5379 Arguments :
5380 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5381 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5382 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5383 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5384 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5385 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5386
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005387 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5388 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5389
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005390 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5391 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5392 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5393 next servers.
5394
5395 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5396 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5397 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5398
5399 Example :
5400 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5401 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5402 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5403
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005404 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5405 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005406
5407
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005408reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5409reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005410 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5412 no | yes | yes | yes
5413 Arguments :
5414 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5415 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5416 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5417 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5418 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5419 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5420 case.
5421
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005422 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5423 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5424
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005425 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5426 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5427 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5428 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005429 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005430
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005431 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005432 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005433 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005434
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005435 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5436 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5437
5438 Example :
5439 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5440 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5441 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5442
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005443 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5444 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005445
5446
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005447reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5448reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005449 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5451 no | yes | yes | yes
5452 Arguments :
5453 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5454 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5455 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5456 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5457 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5458 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5459 case.
5460
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005461 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5462 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5463
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005464 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5465 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5466 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5467 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5468
5469 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5470 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5471
5472 Example :
5473 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5474 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5475 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5476 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5477
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005478 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5479 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005480
5481
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005482reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5483reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005484 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5486 no | yes | yes | yes
5487 Arguments :
5488 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5489 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5490 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5491 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5492 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5493 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5494
5495 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5496 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5497 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5498 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005499 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005500
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005501 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5502 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5503
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005504 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5505 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5506 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5507
5508 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5509 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5510 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5511 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5512 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5513
5514 Example :
5515 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005516 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005517 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5518 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5519
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005520 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5521 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005522
5523
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005524reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5525reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005526 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5528 no | yes | yes | yes
5529 Arguments :
5530 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5531 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5532 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5533 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5534 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5535 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5536 ignores case.
5537
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005538 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5539 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5540
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005541 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5542 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005543 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5544 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5545 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005546 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5547 not set.
5548
5549 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5550 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5551 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5552 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5553 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5554
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005555 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005556 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5557 # block all others.
5558 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5559 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5560
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005561 # block bad guys
5562 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5563 reqitarpit . if badguys
5564
5565 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5566 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005567
5568
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005569retries <value>
5570 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5572 yes | no | yes | yes
5573 Arguments :
5574 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5575 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5576 default value is 3.
5577
5578 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5579 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5580 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5581
5582 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5583 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5584
5585 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5586 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5587
5588 See also : "option redispatch"
5589
5590
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005591rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005592 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5594 no | yes | yes | yes
5595 Arguments :
5596 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5597 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005598 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005599
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005600 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5601 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5602
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005603 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5604 the last header of an HTTP response.
5605
5606 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5607 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5608 responses.
5609
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005610 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5611 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005612
5613
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005614rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5615rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005616 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5618 no | yes | yes | yes
5619 Arguments :
5620 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5621 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5622 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5623 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5624 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5625 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5626 ignores case.
5627
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005628 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5629 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5630
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005631 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5632 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005633 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005634 client.
5635
5636 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5637 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5638 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5639
5640 Example :
5641 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005642 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005643
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005644 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5645 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005646
5647
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005648rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5649rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005650 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5652 no | yes | yes | yes
5653 Arguments :
5654 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5655 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5656 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5657 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5658 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5659 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5660 ignores case.
5661
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005662 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5663 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5664
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005665 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5666 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5667 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5668 case-sensitive.
5669
5670 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005671 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5672 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5673 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005674
5675 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5676 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5677
5678 Example :
5679 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5680 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5681
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005682 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5683 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005684
5685
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005686rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5687rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005688 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5690 no | yes | yes | yes
5691 Arguments :
5692 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5693 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5694 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5695 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5696 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5697 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5698 ignores case.
5699
5700 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5701 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5702 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5703 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005704 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005705
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005706 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5707 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5708
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005709 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5710 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5711 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5712
5713 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5714 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5715 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5716 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5717 are not case-sensitive.
5718
5719 Example :
5720 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5721 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5722
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005723 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5724 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005725
5726
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005727server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005728 Declare a server in a backend
5729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5730 no | no | yes | yes
5731 Arguments :
5732 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005733 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005734 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005735
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005736 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5737 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5738 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5739 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005740 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5741 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5742 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5743 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5744 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005745 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5746 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5747 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5748 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5749 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5750 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5751 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005752 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5753 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5754 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5755 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005756
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005757 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005758 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5759 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5760 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5761 adding this value to the client's port.
5762
5763 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5764 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005765 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005766
5767 Examples :
5768 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5769 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005770 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005771 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5772 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5773 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005774
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005775 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5776 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005777
5778
5779source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005780source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005781source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005782 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5784 yes | no | yes | yes
5785 Arguments :
5786 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5787 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005788
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005789 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005790 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5791 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5792 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5793 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5794 supported prefixes are :
5795 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5796 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5797 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005798 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5799 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5800 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5801 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005802
5803 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5804 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005805 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5806 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5807 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005808
5809 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5810 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5811 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5812 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5813 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5814 <addr>.
5815
5816 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5817 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5818 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5819 port.
5820
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005821 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5822 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5823 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5824 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005825 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005826 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5827 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5828 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5829 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5830 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5831 HTTP header.
5832
5833 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5834 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005835 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005836 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5837 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5838 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5839 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5840 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5841 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5842 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5843
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005844 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5845 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5846 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5847 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5848 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5849 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5850
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005851 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5852 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5853 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5854 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5855
5856 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5857 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5858 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5859 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5860 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5861 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5862
5863 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5864 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5865 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5866 there are two methods :
5867
5868 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5869 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5870 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5871 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5872 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5873 of the client ranges may be used.
5874
5875 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5876 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5877 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5878 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5879 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5880 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5881 same session.
5882
5883 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5884 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5885 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5886 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5887 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5888 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5889
5890 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5891 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5892 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005893 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005894
5895 Examples :
5896 backend private
5897 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5898 source 192.168.1.200
5899
5900 backend transparent_ssl1
5901 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5902 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5903
5904 backend transparent_ssl2
5905 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5906 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5907 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5908
5909 backend transparent_ssl3
5910 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5911 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5912 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5913
5914 backend transparent_smtp
5915 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5916 # with Tproxy version 4.
5917 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5918
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005919 backend transparent_http
5920 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5921 # proxy.
5922 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005924 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005925 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005927
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005928srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5929 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5931 yes | no | yes | yes
5932 Arguments :
5933 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5934 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5935 as explained at the top of this document.
5936
5937 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5938 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5939 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5940 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5941 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5942 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5943 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5944
5945 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5946 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5947 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5948 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5949 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005950 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005951 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005952 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005953
5954 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5955 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5956 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5957 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5958 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5959 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5960
5961 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5962 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5963
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005964 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5965 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005966
5967
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005968stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5969 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005971 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005972
5973 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5974 matched.
5975
5976 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5977 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5978
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005979 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5980 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5981 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5982
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005983 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5984 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5985 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5986 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005987
5988 Example :
5989 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5990 backend stats_localhost
5991 stats enable
5992 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5993
5994 Example :
5995 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5996 backend stats_auth
5997 stats enable
5998 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5999 stats admin if TRUE
6000
6001 Example :
6002 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6003 userlist stats-auth
6004 group admin users admin
6005 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6006 group readonly users haproxy
6007 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6008
6009 backend stats_auth
6010 stats enable
6011 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6012 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6013 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6014 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6015
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006016 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6017 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6018 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006019
6020
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006021stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6022 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006024 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006025 Arguments :
6026 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6027
6028 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6029
6030 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6031 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6032 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6033 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6034 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6035 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6036
6037 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6038 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6039 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006040 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006041
6042 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6043 report using "stats scope".
6044
6045 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6046 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6047 unobvious parameters.
6048
6049 Example :
6050 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6051 backend public_www
6052 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6053 stats enable
6054 stats hide-version
6055 stats scope .
6056 stats uri /admin?stats
6057 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6058 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6059 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6060
6061 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6062 backend private_monitoring
6063 stats enable
6064 stats uri /admin?stats
6065 stats refresh 5s
6066
6067 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6068
6069
6070stats enable
6071 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006073 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006074 Arguments : none
6075
6076 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6077 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6078 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6079 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6080 - stats auth : no authentication
6081 - stats scope : no restriction
6082
6083 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6084 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6085 unobvious parameters.
6086
6087 Example :
6088 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6089 backend public_www
6090 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6091 stats enable
6092 stats hide-version
6093 stats scope .
6094 stats uri /admin?stats
6095 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6096 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6097 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6098
6099 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6100 backend private_monitoring
6101 stats enable
6102 stats uri /admin?stats
6103 stats refresh 5s
6104
6105 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6106
6107
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006108stats hide-version
6109 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006111 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006112 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006113
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006114 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6115 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6116 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6117 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6118 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6119 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006120
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006121 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6122 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6123 unobvious parameters.
6124
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006125 Example :
6126 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6127 backend public_www
6128 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006129 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006130 stats hide-version
6131 stats scope .
6132 stats uri /admin?stats
6133 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6134 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6135 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006136
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006137 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6138 backend private_monitoring
6139 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006140 stats uri /admin?stats
6141 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006142
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006143 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006144
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006145
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006146stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6147 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6148 Access control for statistics
6149
6150 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6151 no | no | yes | yes
6152
6153 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6154 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6155 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6156 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6157 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6158 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6159
6160 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6161 instance.
6162
6163 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6164 about ACL usage.
6165
6166
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006167stats realm <realm>
6168 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006170 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006171 Arguments :
6172 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6173 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6174 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6175
6176 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6177 using a backslash ('\').
6178
6179 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6180 only related to authentication.
6181
6182 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6183 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6184 unobvious parameters.
6185
6186 Example :
6187 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6188 backend public_www
6189 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6190 stats enable
6191 stats hide-version
6192 stats scope .
6193 stats uri /admin?stats
6194 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6195 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6196 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6197
6198 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6199 backend private_monitoring
6200 stats enable
6201 stats uri /admin?stats
6202 stats refresh 5s
6203
6204 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6205
6206
6207stats refresh <delay>
6208 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006210 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006211 Arguments :
6212 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6213 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6214 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6215 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6216 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6217 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6218
6219 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6220 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6221 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6222 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6223
6224 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6225 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6226 unobvious parameters.
6227
6228 Example :
6229 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6230 backend public_www
6231 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6232 stats enable
6233 stats hide-version
6234 stats scope .
6235 stats uri /admin?stats
6236 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6237 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6238 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6239
6240 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6241 backend private_monitoring
6242 stats enable
6243 stats uri /admin?stats
6244 stats refresh 5s
6245
6246 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6247
6248
6249stats scope { <name> | "." }
6250 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006252 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006253 Arguments :
6254 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6255 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6256 section in which the statement appears.
6257
6258 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6259 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6260 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6261 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6262 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6263 exists.
6264
6265 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6266 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6267 unobvious parameters.
6268
6269 Example :
6270 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6271 backend public_www
6272 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6273 stats enable
6274 stats hide-version
6275 stats scope .
6276 stats uri /admin?stats
6277 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6278 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6279 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6280
6281 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6282 backend private_monitoring
6283 stats enable
6284 stats uri /admin?stats
6285 stats refresh 5s
6286
6287 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6288
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006289
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006290stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006291 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006293 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006294
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006295 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006296 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6297
6298 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6299 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6300
6301 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6302 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006303 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006304
6305 Example :
6306 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6307 backend private_monitoring
6308 stats enable
6309 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6310 stats uri /admin?stats
6311 stats refresh 5s
6312
6313 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6314 global section.
6315
6316
6317stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006318 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6320 yes | yes | yes | yes
6321 Arguments : none
6322
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006323 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006324 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6325 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6326 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6327 - IP (socket, server)
6328 - cookie (backend, server)
6329
6330 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6331 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006332 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006333
6334 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6335
6336
6337stats show-node [ <name> ]
6338 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006340 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006341 Arguments:
6342 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6343 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6344
6345 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6346 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006347 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006348
6349 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6350 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6351 unobvious parameters.
6352
6353 Example:
6354 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6355 backend private_monitoring
6356 stats enable
6357 stats show-node Europe-1
6358 stats uri /admin?stats
6359 stats refresh 5s
6360
6361 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6362 section.
6363
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006364
6365stats uri <prefix>
6366 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006368 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006369 Arguments :
6370 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6371 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6372 query string.
6373
6374 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6375 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6376 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6377 possible to reach it in the application.
6378
6379 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006380 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006381 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6382 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6383 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6384 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6385
6386 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6387 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6388 an address or a port to statistics only.
6389
6390 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6391 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6392 unobvious parameters.
6393
6394 Example :
6395 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6396 backend public_www
6397 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6398 stats enable
6399 stats hide-version
6400 stats scope .
6401 stats uri /admin?stats
6402 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6403 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6404 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6405
6406 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6407 backend private_monitoring
6408 stats enable
6409 stats uri /admin?stats
6410 stats refresh 5s
6411
6412 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6413
6414
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006415stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6416 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006418 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006419
6420 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006421 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006422 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6423 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6424 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6425
6426 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6427 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6428 the "stick-table" statement.
6429
6430 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6431 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6432 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6433 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6434 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6435
6436 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6437 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6438 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6439 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6440 transformation rules.
6441
6442 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6443 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6444 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6445 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6446 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6447 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6448 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6449
6450 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6451 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6452 ACL based conditions.
6453
6454 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6455 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6456 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6457 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6458
6459 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6460 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6461 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6462 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6463
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006464 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6465 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6466 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6467
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006468 Example :
6469 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6470 # last 30 minutes
6471 backend pop
6472 mode tcp
6473 balance roundrobin
6474 stick store-request src
6475 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6476 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6477 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6478
6479 backend smtp
6480 mode tcp
6481 balance roundrobin
6482 stick match src table pop
6483 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6484 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6485
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006486 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6487 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006488
6489
6490stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6491 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6493 no | no | yes | yes
6494
6495 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6496 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6497 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6498 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6499
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006500 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6501 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6502 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6503
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006504 Examples :
6505 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006506 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006507
6508 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6509 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6510 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6511
6512
6513 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6514 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6515 backend http
6516 mode http
6517 balance roundrobin
6518 stick on src table https
6519 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6520 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6521 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6522
6523 backend https
6524 mode tcp
6525 balance roundrobin
6526 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6527 stick on src
6528 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6529 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6530
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006531 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006532
6533
6534stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6535 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6537 no | no | yes | yes
6538
6539 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006540 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006541 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6542 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6543 server is selected.
6544
6545 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6546 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6547 the "stick-table" statement.
6548
6549 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6550 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6551 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6552 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6553 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6554 address.
6555
6556 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6557 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6558 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6559 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6560 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6561 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6562 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6563 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6564 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6565 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6566
6567 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6568 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6569 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6570 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6571 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6572 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6573 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6574
6575 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6576 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6577 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6578 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6579
6580 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6581 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6582 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6583 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6584 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6585 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006586 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6587 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6588 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6589 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6590 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6591 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006592
6593 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6594 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6595 the request.
6596
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006597 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6598 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6599 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6600
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006601 Example :
6602 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6603 # last 30 minutes
6604 backend pop
6605 mode tcp
6606 balance roundrobin
6607 stick store-request src
6608 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6609 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6610 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6611
6612 backend smtp
6613 mode tcp
6614 balance roundrobin
6615 stick match src table pop
6616 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6617 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6618
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006619 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6620 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006621
6622
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006623stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006624 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6625 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006626 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006628 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006629
6630 Arguments :
6631 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6632 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6633 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6634 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6635
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006636 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6637 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6638 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6639 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6640
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006641 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6642 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6643 instance.
6644
6645 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6646 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6647 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6648 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6649 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6650 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006651 to 32 characters.
6652
6653 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6654 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6655 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6656 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6657 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6658 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006659
6660 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006661 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6662 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006663 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6664 increase.
6665
6666 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006667 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6668 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6669 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006670
6671 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6672 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6673 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6674 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6675 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6676 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6677 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6678 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6679 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6680 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6681 parameter (see below).
6682
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006683 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6684 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6685 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6686 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6687 soft restart.
6688
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006689 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6690
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006691 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6692 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6693 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6694 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6695 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006696 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006697 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6698 if not expiration delay is specified.
6699
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006700 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6701 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6702 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6703 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006704 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6705 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6706 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6707 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6708 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6709 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6710 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6711 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6712 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6713 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6714 types and their arguments.
6715
6716 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6717 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6718 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6719 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6720
6721 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6722 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6723 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6724 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6725
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006726 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6727 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6728 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6729 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6730 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6731 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6732
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006733 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6734 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6735 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6736 they were received.
6737
6738 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6739 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6740 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6741 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6742 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6743
6744 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6745 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6746 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6747 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6748 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6749
6750 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6751 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6752 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6753
6754 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6755 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6756 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6757 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6758 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6759
6760 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6761 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6762 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6763 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6764 the client side.
6765
6766 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6767 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6768 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6769 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6770 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6771 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6772 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6773
6774 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6775 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6776 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6777 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6778 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6779 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6780 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6781
6782 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6783 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6784 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6785 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6786 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6787 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6788
6789 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6790 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6791 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6792 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6793
6794 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6795 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6796 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6797 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6798 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6799 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6800 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6801 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6802 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6803 recommended for better fairness.
6804
6805 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6806 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6807 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6808 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6809
6810 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6811 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6812 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6813 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6814 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6815 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6816 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6817 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6818 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6819 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006820
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006821 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6822 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006823 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6824 reference it.
6825
6826 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6827 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6828 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6829 as an exclusive stickiness.
6830
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006831 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6832 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6833 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6834 something that can be ignored.
6835
6836 Example:
6837 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6838 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6839 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6840 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6841
6842 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006843 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006844
6845
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006846stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6847 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6849 no | no | yes | yes
6850
6851 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006852 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006853 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6854 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6855 server is selected.
6856
6857 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6858 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6859 the "stick-table" statement.
6860
6861 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6862 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6863 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6864 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6865
6866 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6867 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6868 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6869 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6870 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6871 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006872 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006873 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6874 rules.
6875
6876 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6877 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6878 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6879 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6880 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6881 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6882 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6883
6884 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6885 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6886 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6887 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6888
6889 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6890 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6891 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6892 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6893 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6894 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006895 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6896 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6897 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6898 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6899 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6900 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6901 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6902 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6903 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006904
6905 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6906
6907 Example :
6908 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6909 backend https
6910 mode tcp
6911 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006912 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006913 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006914
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006915 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6916 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6917
6918 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6919 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6920 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6921
6922 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6923 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006924
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006925 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6926 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6927 # at offset 44.
6928
6929 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6930 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6931
6932 # Learn on response if server hello.
6933 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006934
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006935 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6936 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6937
6938 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6939 extraction.
6940
6941
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02006942tcp-check connect [params*]
6943 Opens a new connection
6944 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6945 no | no | yes | yes
6946
6947 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
6948 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
6949 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
6950
6951 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6952 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
6953 of the sequence.
6954
6955 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6956 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6957 do.
6958
6959 Parameters :
6960 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
6961 use the TCP connection.
6962
6963 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
6964 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6965 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
6966
6967 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6968
6969 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6970
6971 Examples:
6972 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6973 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6974 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6975 option tcp-check
6976 tcp-check connect
6977 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6978 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6979 tcp-check send \r\n
6980 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6981 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
6982 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6983 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6984 tcp-check send \r\n
6985 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6986 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6987
6988 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
6989 option tcp-check
6990 tcp-check connect port 110
6991 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
6992 tcp-check connect port 143
6993 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
6994 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
6995
6996 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
6997
6998
6999tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7000 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7002 no | no | yes | yes
7003
7004 Arguments :
7005 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7006 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7007 binary.
7008 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7009 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7010 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7011
7012 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7013 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7014 with the usual backslash ('\').
7015 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7016 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7017 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7018 used upper or lower case.
7019
7020
7021 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7022
7023 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7024 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7025 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7026 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7027 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7028 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7029 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7030 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7031
7032 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7033 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7034 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7035 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7036 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7037 expression.
7038
7039 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7040 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7041 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7042 this exact hexadecimal string.
7043 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7044
7045 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7046 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7047 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7048 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7049 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7050 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7051 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7052 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7053 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7054 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7055 the null character.
7056
7057 Examples :
7058 # perform a POP check
7059 option tcp-check
7060 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7061
7062 # perform an IMAP check
7063 option tcp-check
7064 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7065
7066 # look for the redis master server
7067 option tcp-check
7068 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7069 tcp-check expect +PONG
7070 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7071 tcp-check expect string role:master
7072 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7073 tcp-check expect string +OK
7074
7075
7076 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7077 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7078
7079
7080tcp-check send <data>
7081 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7082 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7083 no | no | yes | yes
7084
7085 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7086 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7087
7088 Examples :
7089 # look for the redis master server
7090 option tcp-check
7091 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7092 tcp-check expect string role:master
7093
7094 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7095 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7096
7097
7098tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7099 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7100 tcp health check
7101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7102 no | no | yes | yes
7103
7104 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7105 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7106 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7107 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7108 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7109 hexadecimal string.
7110 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7111
7112 Examples :
7113 # redis check in binary
7114 option tcp-check
7115 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7116 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7117
7118
7119 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7120 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7121
7122
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007123tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7124 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7126 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007127 Arguments :
7128 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007129 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7130 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007132 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007133
7134 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7135 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007136 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7137 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7138 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7139 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7140 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7141 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007142
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007143 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7144 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7145 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7146 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007147
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007148 Three types of actions are supported :
7149 - accept :
7150 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7151 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7152 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007153
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007154 - reject :
7155 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7156 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7157 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7158 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7159 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7160 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7161 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7162 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7163 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7164 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7165 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7166 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007167
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007168 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7169 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7170 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7171 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7172 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7173 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7174 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7175 hosts.
7176
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007177 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007178 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7179 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7180 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007181 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7182 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007183 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007184 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7185 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7186 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7187 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7188 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007189
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007190 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007191 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007192 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007193 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7194 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7195 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7196 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007197
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007198 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7199 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7200 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7201 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007202
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007203 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7204 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7205 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7206 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7207 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007208 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7209 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7210 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7211 layer7 information is extracted.
7212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007213 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7214 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7215 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7216 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7217 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007218
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007219 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7220 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7221 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007222
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007223 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7224 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7225 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007227 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007228 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007229 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007230
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007231 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7232 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7233 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007234
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007235 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007236 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7237 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007238
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007239 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7240
7241 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7242
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007243 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7244
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007245 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007246
7247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007248tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7249 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007251 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007252 Arguments :
7253 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007254 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7255 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007256 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007258 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007259
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007260 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7261 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7262 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7263 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7264 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007266 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7267 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7268 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7269 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007270 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7271 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7272 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7273 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7274 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7275 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007276 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007277 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007279 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7280 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7281 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7282 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007284 Three types of actions are supported :
7285 - accept :
7286 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007287 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007288
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007289 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7290 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007291
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007292 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7293 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7294 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7295 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7296 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7297 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007299 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007300 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7301 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007302
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007303 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007304 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7305 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7306 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7307 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007308 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7309 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7310 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007311
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007312 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7313 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7314 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7315 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7316
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007317 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007318 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7319 # and reject everything else.
7320 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7321 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007322 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007323 tcp-request content reject
7324
7325 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007326 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7327 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7328 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007329 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007330
7331 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7332 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7333 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007334 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007335 tcp-request content reject
7336
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007337 Example:
7338 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7339 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007340 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007341
7342 Example:
7343 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7344 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007345 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007346
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007347 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7348 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7349
7350 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007351 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007352 # protecting all our sites
7353 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007354 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7355 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007356 ...
7357 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7358
7359 backend http_dynamic
7360 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007361 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007362 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007363 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7364 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7365 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007366 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007368 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007370 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007371
7372
7373tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7374 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007376 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007377 Arguments :
7378 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7379 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7380 as explained at the top of this document.
7381
7382 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7383 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7384 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7385 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7386 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7387
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007388 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7389 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7390 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7391 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7392
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007393 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7394 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007395 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007396 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007397 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7398 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7399 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7400 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007401
7402 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7403 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7404 it pass through unaffected.
7405
7406 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7407 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7408 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007409 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007410 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7411 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007412 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7413 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7414 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007415
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007416 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007417 "timeout client".
7418
7419
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007420tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7421 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7423 no | no | yes | yes
7424 Arguments :
7425 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007426 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007427
7428 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7429
7430 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7431 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7432 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007433 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7434 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007435
7436 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7437
7438 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7439 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7440 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7441 inserted.
7442
7443 Two types of actions are supported :
7444 - accept :
7445 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7446 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7447 the rules evaluation.
7448
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007449 - close :
7450 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7451 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7452 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7453 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7454 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7455 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007456 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007457 protocols.
7458
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007459 - reject :
7460 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7461 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007462 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007463
7464 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7465 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7466 for changing the default action to a reject.
7467
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007468 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7469 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7470 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7471 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007472 period.
7473
7474 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7475
7476 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7477
7478
7479tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7480 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7482 no | no | yes | yes
7483 Arguments :
7484 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7485 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7486 as explained at the top of this document.
7487
7488 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7489
7490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007491timeout check <timeout>
7492 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7493 established.
7494
7495 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7496 yes | no | yes | yes
7497 Arguments:
7498 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7499 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7500 as explained at the top of this document.
7501
7502 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7503 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7504 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7505 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007506 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7507 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7508 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007509
7510 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7511 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7512
7513 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7514 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007515 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007516
7517 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7518 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7519 forget about it.
7520
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007521 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7522 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007523
7524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007525timeout client <timeout>
7526timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7527 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7529 yes | yes | yes | no
7530 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007531 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007532 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7533 as explained at the top of this document.
7534
7535 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7536 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7537 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7538 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7539 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7540 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7541 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7542 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007543 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007544 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007545 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7546 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7547 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007548
7549 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7550 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7551 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7552 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7553 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7554 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7555
7556 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7557 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7558 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7559
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007560 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007561
7562
7563timeout connect <timeout>
7564timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7565 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7567 yes | no | yes | yes
7568 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007569 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007570 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7571 as explained at the top of this document.
7572
7573 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007574 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007575 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007576 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007577 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7578 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007579
7580 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7581 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7582 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7583 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7584 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7585 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7586
7587 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7588 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7589 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7590
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007591 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7592 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007593
7594
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007595timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7596 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7598 yes | yes | yes | yes
7599 Arguments :
7600 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7601 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7602 as explained at the top of this document.
7603
7604 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7605 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7606 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7607 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7608 once the request has started to present itself.
7609
7610 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7611 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7612 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7613 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7614 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7615
7616 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7617 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7618 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7619 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7620
7621 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7622 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7623 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7624 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7625 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007626 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007627
7628 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7629 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7630 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7631 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7632
7633 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7634
7635
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007636timeout http-request <timeout>
7637 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007639 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007640 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007641 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007642 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7643 as explained at the top of this document.
7644
7645 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7646 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7647 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7648 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7649 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7650 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7651 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7652 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7653
7654 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7655 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007656 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7657 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007658
7659 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7660 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7661 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7662 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7663 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7664
7665 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007666 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7667 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7668 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007669
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007670 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007671
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007672
7673timeout queue <timeout>
7674 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7676 yes | no | yes | yes
7677 Arguments :
7678 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7679 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7680 as explained at the top of this document.
7681
7682 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7683 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7684 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7685 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7686 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7687
7688 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7689 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7690 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7691 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7692
7693 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7694
7695
7696timeout server <timeout>
7697timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7698 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7700 yes | no | yes | yes
7701 Arguments :
7702 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7703 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7704 as explained at the top of this document.
7705
7706 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7707 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7708 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7709 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7710 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7711 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7712 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7713
7714 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7715 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7716 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7717 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7718 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007719 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007720 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007721 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7722 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7723 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7724 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007725
7726 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7727 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7728 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7729 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7730 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7731 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7732
7733 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7734 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7735 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7736
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007737 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007738
7739
7740timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007741 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7743 yes | yes | yes | yes
7744 Arguments :
7745 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7746 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7747 as explained at the top of this document.
7748
7749 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7750 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7751 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7752
7753 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7754 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7755 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7756 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007757 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007758
7759 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7760
7761
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007762timeout tunnel <timeout>
7763 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7765 yes | no | yes | yes
7766 Arguments :
7767 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7768 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7769 as explained at the top of this document.
7770
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007771 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007772 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7773 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7774 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7775 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7776 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7777 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7778 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7779 specified.
7780
7781 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7782 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7783 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7784 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7785 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7786
7787 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7788 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7789 forget about it.
7790
7791 Example :
7792 defaults http
7793 option http-server-close
7794 timeout connect 5s
7795 timeout client 30s
7796 timeout client 30s
7797 timeout server 30s
7798 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7799
7800 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7801
7802
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007803transparent (deprecated)
7804 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007806 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007807 Arguments : none
7808
7809 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7810 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7811 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7812 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7813 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7814 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7815 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7816 appropriate server.
7817
7818 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7819
7820 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7821 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7822
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007823 See also: "option transparent"
7824
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007825unique-id-format <string>
7826 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7828 yes | yes | yes | no
7829 Arguments :
7830 <string> is a log-format string.
7831
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007832 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7833 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7834 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7835 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007836
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007837 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7838 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7839 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7840 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7841 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7842 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7843 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7844 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007845
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007846 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7847 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007848
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007849 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007850
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007851 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007852
7853 will generate:
7854
7855 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7856
7857 See also: "unique-id-header"
7858
7859unique-id-header <name>
7860 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7862 yes | yes | yes | no
7863 Arguments :
7864 <name> is the name of the header.
7865
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007866 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7867 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007868
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007869 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007870
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007871 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007872 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7873
7874 will generate:
7875
7876 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7877
7878 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007879
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007880use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007881 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7883 no | yes | yes | no
7884 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007885 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7886 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007887
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007888 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
7889 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007890
7891 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7892 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7893 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007894 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7895 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7896 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7897 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007898
7899 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7900 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7901 assign the backend.
7902
7903 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7904 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7905 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7906 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7907 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7908 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7909
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007910 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007911 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007912 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7913 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7914 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7915
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007916 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7917 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7918 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
7919 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
7920 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
7921 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
7922 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
7923 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
7924 cannot be forced from the request.
7925
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007926 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007927 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
7928 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
7929
7930 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
7931 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007932
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007933
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007934use-server <server> if <condition>
7935use-server <server> unless <condition>
7936 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7938 no | no | yes | yes
7939 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007940 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007941
7942 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7943
7944 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7945 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7946 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7947
7948 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7949 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7950 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7951 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7952 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7953 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7954 matches will assign the server.
7955
7956 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7957 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7958 with the next rules until one matches.
7959
7960 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7961 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7962 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7963 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7964
7965 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7966 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7967 stripped.
7968
7969 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7970 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7971 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7972 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7973
7974 Example :
7975 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7976 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7977 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7978 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7979 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7980 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7981 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7982 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7983 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7984
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007985 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007986
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007987
79885. Bind and Server options
7989--------------------------
7990
7991The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7992depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7993settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7994written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7995described in this section.
7996
7997
79985.1. Bind options
7999-----------------
8000
8001The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8002as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8003no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8004parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8005while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8006provided immediately after the setting name.
8007
8008The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8009
8010accept-proxy
8011 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
8012 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
8013 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8014 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8015 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8016 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8017 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8018 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8019 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008020 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8021 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008022
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008023alpn <protocols>
8024 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8025 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8026 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8027 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8028 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8029 initial NPN extension.
8030
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008031backlog <backlog>
8032 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8033 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8034
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008035ecdhe <named curve>
8036 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008037 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8038 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008039
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008040ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008041 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8042 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8043 client's certificate.
8044
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008045ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8046 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8047 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8048 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8049 error is ignored.
8050
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008051ciphers <ciphers>
8052 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8053 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008054 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008055 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8056 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8057
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008058crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008059 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8060 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8061 to verify client's certificate.
8062
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008063crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8065 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8066 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8067 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8068 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8069 file.
8070
8071 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8072 are loaded.
8073
8074 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
8075 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
8076 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8077 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8078 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8079 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8080 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8081 www.sub.example.org).
8082
8083 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8084 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8085 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8086 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8087 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8088
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008089 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008090
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008091 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8092 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008093 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008094 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8095 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8096 clients).
8097
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008098crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8100 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008101 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008102 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008103
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008104crt-list <file>
8105 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008106 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8107 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008108
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008109 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008110
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008111 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8112 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8113 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8114 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8115 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8116 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8117 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8118 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008120defer-accept
8121 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8122 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8123 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8124 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8125 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8126 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8127 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8128 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8129 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8130 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8131 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8132
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008133force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008134 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008135 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8136 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8137
8138force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008139 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008140 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8141
8142force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008143 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008144 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8145
8146force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008147 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008148 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8149
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008150gid <gid>
8151 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8152 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8153 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8154 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8155 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8156
8157group <group>
8158 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8159 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8160 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8161 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8162 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8163
8164id <id>
8165 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8166 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8167 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8168 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8169
8170interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008171 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8172 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8173 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8174 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8175 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8176 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8177 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008178
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008179level <level>
8180 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8181 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8182 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8183 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8184 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8185 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8186 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8187 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8188 counters).
8189 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8190 all counters).
8191
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008192maxconn <maxconn>
8193 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8194 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8195 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8196 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8197 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8198 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8199 eat all memory.
8200
8201mode <mode>
8202 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8203 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8204 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8205 UNIX sockets.
8206
8207mss <maxseg>
8208 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8209 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8210 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8211 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8212 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8213 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8214 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8215 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8216 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8217 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8218 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8219
8220name <name>
8221 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8222 page.
8223
8224nice <nice>
8225 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8226 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8227 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8228 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8229 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8230 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8231 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8232 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8233 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8234 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8235 one for an RDP socket.
8236
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008237no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008238 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008239 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008240 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008241 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8242 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008243
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008244no-tls-tickets
8245 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8246 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8247 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8248 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8249
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008250no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008252 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008253 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8254 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8255 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008256
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008257no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008258 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008259 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008260 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8261 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8262 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008263
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008264no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008266 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008267 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8268 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8269 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008270
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008271npn <protocols>
8272 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8273 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8274 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8275 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008276 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8277 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008278
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008279process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8280 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8281 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8282 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8283 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8284 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8285 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8286 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
8287 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. See
8288 also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
8289
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008290ssl
8291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008292 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008293 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8294 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8295 to deciphered contents.
8296
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008297strict-sni
8298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8299 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8300 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8301 See the "crt" option for more information.
8302
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008303tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008304 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008305 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8306 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8307 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8308 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8309 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8310 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8311 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008312 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8313 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8314 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008315
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008316transparent
8317 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8318 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8319 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8320 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8321 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8322 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8323 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8324 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8325 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8326 so check for support with your vendor.
8327
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008328v4v6
8329 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8330 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8331 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8332 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008333 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008334
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008335v6only
8336 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8337 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8338 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008339 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8340 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008342uid <uid>
8343 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8344 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8345 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8346 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8347 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8348
8349user <user>
8350 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8351 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8352 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8353 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8354 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8355
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008356verify [none|optional|required]
8357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8358 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8359 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8360 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8361 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008362 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8363 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8364 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8365 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008366
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020083675.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008368------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008370The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8371which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8372arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8373settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8374after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8375Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8376address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008378 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008379 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008381The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008382
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008383addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008384 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8385 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8386 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8387 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8388 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008390 Supported in default-server: No
8391
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008392agent-check
8393 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8394 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8395 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8396 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8397
8398 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8399 e.g. "75%"
8400
8401 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8402 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8403
8404 * The string "drain".
8405
8406 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8407 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8408 persistence.
8409
8410 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8411
8412 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8413
8414 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8415
8416 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8417
8418 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8419
8420 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8421
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008422 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8423 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8424 parameter.
8425
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008426 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8427 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8428
8429 Supported in default-server: No
8430
8431agent-inter <delay>
8432 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8433 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8434
8435 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8436 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8437 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8438 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8439 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8440 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8441 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8442 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8443 of backends use the same servers.
8444
8445 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8446
8447 Supported in default-server: Yes
8448
8449agent-port <port>
8450 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8451
8452 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8453
8454 Supported in default-server: Yes
8455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008456backup
8457 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8458 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8459 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8460 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8461 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8462 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008464 Supported in default-server: No
8465
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008466ca-file <cafile>
8467 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8468 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8469 server's certificate.
8470
8471 Supported in default-server: No
8472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008473check
8474 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008475 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8476 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8477 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8478 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8479 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8480 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8481 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008482 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8483 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8484 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008486 Supported in default-server: No
8487
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008488check-send-proxy
8489 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8490 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8491 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8492 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8493 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8494 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8495 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8496
8497 Supported in default-server: No
8498
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008499check-ssl
8500 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8501 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8502 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8503 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008504 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008505 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8506 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8507 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8508 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8509
8510 Supported in default-server: No
8511
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008512ciphers <ciphers>
8513 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008514 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008515 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8516 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8517 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8518 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8519 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8520 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8521
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008522 Supported in default-server: No
8523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008524cookie <value>
8525 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8526 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8527 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8528 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8529 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8530 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8531 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008533 Supported in default-server: No
8534
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008535crl-file <crlfile>
8536 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8537 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8538 to verify server's certificate.
8539
8540 Supported in default-server: No
8541
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008542crt <cert>
8543 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8544 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8545 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8546 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8547 certificate request.
8548
8549 Supported in default-server: No
8550
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008551disabled
8552 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8553 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8554 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8555 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8556 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8557
8558 Supported in default-server: No
8559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008560error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008561 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8562 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8563 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008564
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008565 Supported in default-server: Yes
8566
8567 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008569fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008570 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8571 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8572 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008574 Supported in default-server: Yes
8575
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008576force-sslv3
8577 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8578 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8579 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8580
8581 Supported in default-server: No
8582
8583force-tlsv10
8584 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8585 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8586
8587 Supported in default-server: No
8588
8589force-tlsv11
8590 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8591 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8592
8593 Supported in default-server: No
8594
8595force-tlsv12
8596 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8597 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8598
8599 Supported in default-server: No
8600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008601id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008602 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8603 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8604 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008606 Supported in default-server: No
8607
8608inter <delay>
8609fastinter <delay>
8610downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008611 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8612 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8613 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8614 between checks depending on the server state :
8615
8616 Server state | Interval used
8617 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8618 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8619 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8620 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8621 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8622 or yet unchecked. |
8623 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8624 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8625 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008627 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8628 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8629 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8630 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008631 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8632 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8633 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8634 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8635 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008637 Supported in default-server: Yes
8638
8639maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008640 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8641 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8642 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8643 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8644 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8645 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8646 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8647 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008649 Supported in default-server: Yes
8650
8651maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008652 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8653 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8654 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8655 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8656 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8657 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8658 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008660 Supported in default-server: Yes
8661
8662minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008663 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8664 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8665 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8666 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8667 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8668 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008669 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008670 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008672 Supported in default-server: Yes
8673
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008674no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008675 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8676 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008677 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008678
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008679 Supported in default-server: No
8680
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008681no-tls-tickets
8682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8683 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8684 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8685 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8686
8687 Supported in default-server: No
8688
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008689no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008690 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008691 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8692 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008693 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8694 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008695
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008696 Supported in default-server: No
8697
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008698no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008699 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008700 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8701 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008702 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8703 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008704
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008705 Supported in default-server: No
8706
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008707no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008708 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008709 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8710 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008711 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8712 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008713
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008714 Supported in default-server: No
8715
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008716non-stick
8717 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8718 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8719 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8720
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008721 Supported in default-server: No
8722
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008723observe <mode>
8724 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8725 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8726 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8727 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8728 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8729 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008730 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008732 Supported in default-server: No
8733
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008734 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008736on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008737 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8738 Currently, four modes are available:
8739 - fastinter: force fastinter
8740 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8741 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8742 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8743 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008745 Supported in default-server: Yes
8746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008747 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8748
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008749on-marked-down <action>
8750 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8751 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008752 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8753 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8754 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8755 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8756 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8757 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8758 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8759 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008760
8761 Actions are disabled by default
8762
8763 Supported in default-server: Yes
8764
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008765on-marked-up <action>
8766 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8767 Currently one action is available:
8768 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8769 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8770 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8771 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8772 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8773 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8774 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8775 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8776
8777 Actions are disabled by default
8778
8779 Supported in default-server: Yes
8780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008781port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008782 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8783 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8784 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8785 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8786 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8787 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8788
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008789 Supported in default-server: Yes
8790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008791redir <prefix>
8792 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8793 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8794 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8795 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8796 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8797 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8798 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8799 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008800 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008801 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8802 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8803 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8804 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8805 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8806
8807 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008809 Supported in default-server: No
8810
8811rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008812 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8813 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8814 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008816 Supported in default-server: Yes
8817
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008818send-proxy
8819 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8820 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8821 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8822 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8823 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8824 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8825 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8826 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8827 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008828 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8829 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8830 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8831 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8832 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008833
8834 Supported in default-server: No
8835
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04008836send-proxy-v2
8837 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
8838 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8839 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8840 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8841 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
8842 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
8843 option of the "bind" keyword.
8844
8845 Supported in default-server: No
8846
8847send-proxy-v2-ssl
8848 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8849 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8850 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8851 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8852 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8853 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
8854 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
8855 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8856
8857 Supported in default-server: No
8858
8859send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
8860 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8861 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8862 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8863 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8864 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8865 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
8866 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
8867 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
8868 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8869
8870 Supported in default-server: No
8871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008872slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008873 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8874 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8875 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8876 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8877 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8878 parameters :
8879
8880 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8881 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8882
8883 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8884 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8885 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8886 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8887
8888 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8889 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8890 seen as failed.
8891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008892 Supported in default-server: Yes
8893
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008894source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008895source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008896source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008897 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8898 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8899 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8900 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8901
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008902 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8903 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8904 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8905 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8906 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8907 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8908 server.
8909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008910 Supported in default-server: No
8911
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008912ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008913 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8914 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8915 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8916 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8917 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8918 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008919 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008920
8921 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008923track [<proxy>/]<server>
8924 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8925 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8926 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8927 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8928 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008930 Supported in default-server: No
8931
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008932verify [none|required]
8933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008934 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8935 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8936 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8937 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008938 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8939 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8940 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008941
8942 Supported in default-server: No
8943
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008944verifyhost <hostname>
8945 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8946 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8947 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8948 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8949 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8950 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8951
8952 Supported in default-server: No
8953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008954weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008955 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8956 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8957 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008958 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8959 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8960 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8961 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8962 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8963 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008965 Supported in default-server: Yes
8966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008967
89686. HTTP header manipulation
8969---------------------------
8970
8971In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8972response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8973request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8974which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008975against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008976
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008977If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
8978to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
8979but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
8980HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
8981stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
8982because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
8983a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
8984still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008985
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008986This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8987in section 4.2 :
8988
8989 - reqadd <string>
8990 - reqallow <search>
8991 - reqiallow <search>
8992 - reqdel <search>
8993 - reqidel <search>
8994 - reqdeny <search>
8995 - reqideny <search>
8996 - reqpass <search>
8997 - reqipass <search>
8998 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8999 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9000 - reqtarpit <search>
9001 - reqitarpit <search>
9002 - rspadd <string>
9003 - rspdel <search>
9004 - rspidel <search>
9005 - rspdeny <search>
9006 - rspideny <search>
9007 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9008 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9009
9010With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9011is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9012parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9013prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9014Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9015
9016 \t for a tab
9017 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9018 \n for a new line (LF)
9019 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9020 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9021 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9022 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9023 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9024
9025The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9026portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9027above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9028regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
90299 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9030is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9031
9032The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9033after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9034
9035Notes related to these keywords :
9036---------------------------------
9037 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9038 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9039 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9040
9041 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9042 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9043 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9044
9045 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9046 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9047 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9048 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9049 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9050
9051 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9052 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9053 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9054 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9055 useless headers before adding new ones.
9056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009057 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009058 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9059
9060 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9061 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9062 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9063
9064 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9065 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009066 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009067
9068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020090697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9070----------------------------------
9071
9072Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9073client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9074The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9075these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9076but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9077data called patterns.
9078
9079
90807.1. ACL basics
9081---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009082
9083The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9084content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9085from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9086simple :
9087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009088 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009089 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009090 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9091 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009093The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9094adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009095
9096In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009098 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009099
9100This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9101Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9102and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009103an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9104conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9105as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9106are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009107
9108ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9109'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9110which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9111
9112There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9113performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009115The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9116specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9117this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009118methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9119ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009120
9121Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9122 - boolean
9123 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9124 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9125 - string
9126 - data block
9127
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009128Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9129converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9130would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9131The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9132which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009134The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9135 - boolean
9136 - integer or integer range
9137 - IP address / network
9138 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9139 - regular expression
9140 - hex block
9141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009142The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9143
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009144 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9145 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009146 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009147 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009148 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009149 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009150 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009152The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9153read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9154if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9155lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9156will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9157beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9158a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9159lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9160exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9161
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009162The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9163parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9164ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9165a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9166check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9167
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009168The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9169socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9170file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009172Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9173loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9174
9175 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9176
9177In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9178the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9179case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9180as well.
9181
9182The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9183sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9184do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9185methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9186is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9187obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9188followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9189default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9190that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9191string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9192
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009193The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9194By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9195string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9196resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9197server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9198waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9199flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9200function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009202There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9203sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9204be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009205
9206 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9207 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009208 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9209 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9210 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9211 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009212
9213 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9214 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009215 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009216
9217 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009218 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009219
9220 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009221 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009222
9223 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9224 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9225
9226 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9227 binary or string samples.
9228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009229 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9230 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009232 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9233 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9234 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009236 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9237 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009239 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9240 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009242 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9243 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009245 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9246 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009247 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009249 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9250 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9251 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009252
9253For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9254request, it is possible to do :
9255
9256 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9257
9258In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9259buffer, one would use the following acl :
9260
9261 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9262
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009263On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9264possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9265
9266 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009268All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9269criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9270method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9271to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9272criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9273the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009275If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009276the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9277For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009279 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9280 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9281 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9282 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009283
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009284
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009285The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009286and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9287combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
9288the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009290 +-------------------------------------------------+
9291 | Input sample type |
9292 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9293 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
9294 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9295 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9296 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009297 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009298 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009299 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009300 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009301 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009302 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009303 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009304 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009305 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009306 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009307 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009308 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009309 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009310 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009311 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009312 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009313 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009314 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009315 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009316 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009317 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009318 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9319 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9320 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009321
9322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093237.1.1. Matching booleans
9324------------------------
9325
9326In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9327Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9328When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9329that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9330
9331Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9332return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9333"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9334
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093367.1.2. Matching integers
9337------------------------
9338
9339Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9340enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9341to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9342
9343Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9344matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9345lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009346
9347For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9348unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9349representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9350
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009351As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9352two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9353instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9354ranges and operators.
9355
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009356For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009357operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9358Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9359of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009360
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009361Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009362
9363 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9364 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9365 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9366 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9367 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009369For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009370
9371 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9372
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009373This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9374
9375 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9376
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093787.1.3. Matching strings
9379-----------------------
9380
9381String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9382different forms :
9383
9384 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9385 patterns ;
9386
9387 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9388 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9389
9390 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9391 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9392
9393 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9394 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9395
9396 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9397 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9398 matches.
9399
9400 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9401 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9402 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009403
9404String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9405exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9406characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9407string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9408to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009409before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009410
9411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094127.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9413---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009414
9415Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9416they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9417possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9418passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9419the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009420the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9421match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009422
9423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094247.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9425-------------------------------------
9426
9427It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9428not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9429a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9430to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9431digits may be used upper or lower case.
9432
9433Example :
9434 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9435 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9436
9437
94387.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9439---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009440
9441IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9442netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9443within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009444host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009445difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9446at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9447does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9448parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009449
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009450IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9451Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9452trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9453IPv6 patterns.
9454
9455HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9456following situations :
9457 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9458 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9459 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9460 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9461 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9462 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9463 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9464 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9465 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9466 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009468
94697.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9470----------------------------------
9471
9472Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9473combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9474
9475 - AND (implicit)
9476 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9477 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009479A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009481 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009483Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9484indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009486For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9487"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9488requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9489is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9490
9491 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9492 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9493 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9494 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9495
9496To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9497and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9498
9499 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9500 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9501 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9502 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9503
9504 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9505 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9506 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9507 use_backend www if host_www
9508
9509It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9510expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9511be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9512the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9513
9514 The following rule :
9515
9516 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9517 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9518
9519 Can also be written that way :
9520
9521 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9522
9523It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9524to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9525simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9526sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9527good use is the following :
9528
9529 With named ACLs :
9530
9531 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9532 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9533 monitor fail if site_dead
9534
9535 With anonymous ACLs :
9536
9537 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9538
9539See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9540
9541
95427.3. Fetching samples
9543---------------------
9544
9545Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9546against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9547sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9548ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9549of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9550available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9551
9552This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9553Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9554compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9555deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9556
9557The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9558matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9559method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9560indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9561
9562As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9563when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9564mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9565the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9566ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9567
9568Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9569multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9570when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9571incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9572are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9573is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9574all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9575
9576Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9577 - name
9578 - name(arg1)
9579 - name(arg1,arg2)
9580
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009581
95827.3.1. Converters
9583-----------------
9584
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009585Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9586of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9587is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9588was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9589has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9590unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9591
9592These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9593sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9594the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9595support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009597The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009598
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009599base64
9600 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9601 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9602 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9603
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009604lower
9605 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9606 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9607 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009608
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009609upper
9610 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9611 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9612 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009613
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009614hex
9615 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9616 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9617 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9618 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009619
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009620ipmask(<mask>)
9621 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9622 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9623 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9624 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009625
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009626http_date([<offset>])
9627 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9628 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9629 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9630 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9631 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9632 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009633
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009634language(<value>[,<default>])
9635 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9636 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9637 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9638 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9639 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9640 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9641 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9642 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9643 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9644 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9645 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9646 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009647
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009648 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009649
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009650 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9651 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009652
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009653 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9654 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9655 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9656 use_backend spanish if es
9657 use_backend french if fr
9658 use_backend english if en
9659 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009660
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009661map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9662map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9663map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9664 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9665 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9666 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9667 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9668 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9669 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9670 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9671 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009672
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009673 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9674 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9675 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009676
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009677 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9678 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009679
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009680 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9681 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9682 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9683 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9684 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9685 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9686 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9687 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9688 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9689 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9690 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9691 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9692 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9693 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9694 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9695 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9696 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9697 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009698
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009699 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9700 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9701 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9702 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9703 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009704
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009705 Example :
9706
9707 # this is a comment and is ignored
9708 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9709 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9710 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9711 | | | `---------- value
9712 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9713 | `---------------------------- key
9714 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9715
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009716
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020097177.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009718--------------------------------------------
9719
9720A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9721not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9722"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9723The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9724
9725always_false : boolean
9726 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9727 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9728
9729always_true : boolean
9730 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9731 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9732
9733avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009734 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009735 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9736 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9737 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9738 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9739 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9740 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9741 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9742 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9743 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9744 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9745 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9746 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9747 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009749be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009750 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9751 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9752 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9753 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9754 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009756be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9757 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9758 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9759 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9760 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9761 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9762 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009763
9764 Example :
9765 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9766 backend dynamic
9767 mode http
9768 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9769 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009771connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9772 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009773 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009774 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9775 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009776
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009777 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009778 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009779 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9780
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009781 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9782 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009783
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009784 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009785 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009786 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009787 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9788 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009789 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009790 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009791
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009792 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9793 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009794 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009795 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009796
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009797date([<offset>]) : integer
9798 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9799 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9800 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9801 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009802 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9803
9804 Example :
9805
9806 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9807 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009808
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009809env(<name>) : string
9810 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9811 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9812 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9813 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9814 certain way.
9815
9816 Examples :
9817 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9818 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9819
9820 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9821 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009823fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9824 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009825 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9826 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009827 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9828 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9829 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9830 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9831 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009833fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9834 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9835 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9836 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9837 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9838 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9839 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9840 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9841 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009842
9843 Example :
9844 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9845 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9846 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9847 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9848 frontend mail
9849 bind :25
9850 mode tcp
9851 maxconn 100
9852 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9853 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9854 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9855 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009857nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9858 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9859 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9860 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009861 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9862 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9863 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009865queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009866 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9867 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9868 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009869 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9870 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9871 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9872 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9873 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9874
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +01009875rand([<range>]) : integer
9876 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
9877 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
9878 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
9879 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
9880 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
9881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009882srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9883 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9884 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9885 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9886 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9887 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9888 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9889 methods.
9890
9891srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9892 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9893 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9894 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9895 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9896 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9897 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9898 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9899
9900srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9901 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9902 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009903 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009904 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9905 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9906 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9907 overloading servers).
9908
9909 Example :
9910 # Redirect to a separate back
9911 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9912 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9913 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9914
9915table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9916 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9917 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9918
9919table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9920 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9921 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9922 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9923
9924
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020099257.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009926----------------------------------
9927
9928The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9929closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9930methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9931sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9932TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009933the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9934counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9935"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009936argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9937the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9938this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009939
9940be_id : integer
9941 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9942 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9943
9944dst : ip
9945 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9946 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9947 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9948 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9949 RFC 4291.
9950
9951dst_conn : integer
9952 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9953 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9954 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9955 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9956 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9957 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9958 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9959 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009961dst_port : integer
9962 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9963 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9964 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9965 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9966 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9967 an HTTP header.
9968
9969fe_id : integer
9970 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9971 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9972 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9973
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009974sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009975sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9976sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9977sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009978 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9979 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9980 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9981
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009982sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009983sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9984sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9985sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009986 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9987 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9988 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9989
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009990sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009991sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9992sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9993sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009994 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9995 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009996 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9997 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9998 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009999
10000 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10001 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010002 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10003 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10004 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010005 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10006 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10007
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010008sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010009sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10010sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10011sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010012 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10013 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10014
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010015sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010016sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10017sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10018sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010019 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10020 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10021 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10022
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010023sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010024sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10025sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10026sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010027 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10028 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10029 See also src_conn_rate.
10030
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010031sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010032sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10033sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10034sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010035 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010036 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010037
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010038sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010039sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10040sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10041sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010042 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10043 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10044 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010045 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10046 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10047 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010048
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010049sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010050sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10051sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10052sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010053 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10054 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10055 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10056
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010057sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010058sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10059sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10060sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010061 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10062 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10063 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10064 src_http_err_rate.
10065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010066sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010067sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10068sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10069sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010070 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10071 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10072 src_http_req_cnt.
10073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010074sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010075sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10076sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10077sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010078 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10079 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10080 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10081 src_http_req_rate.
10082
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010083sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010084sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10085sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10086sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010087 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010088 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10089 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10090 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10091 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010092
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010093 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10094 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010095 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10096
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010097sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010098sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10099sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10100sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010101 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10102 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10103 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10104 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10105
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010106sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010107sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10108sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10109sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010110 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10111 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10112 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10113 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10114
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010115sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010116sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10117sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10118sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010119 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10120 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10121 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10122 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010123 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010124 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10125
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010126sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010127sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10128sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10129sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010130 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10131 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10132 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10133 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10134 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010135 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010136
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010137sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010138sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10139sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10140sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010141 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10142 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10143 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10144
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010145sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010146sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10147sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10148sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010149 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10150 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010151 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010152 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10153 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010154 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10155 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10156 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010158so_id : integer
10159 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10160 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10161 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010163src : ip
10164 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10165 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10166 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10167 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10168 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10169 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10170 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010171
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010172 Example:
10173 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10174 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010176src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10177 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10178 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10179 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010180 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010182src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10183 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10184 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010185 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010186 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010188src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10189 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10190 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10191 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10192 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10193 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10194 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010195
10196 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10197 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10198 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10199 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010200 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010201 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10202 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010204src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010205 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010206 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010207 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010208 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010210src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010211 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010212 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10213 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010214 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010216src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10217 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10218 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10219 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010220 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010222src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010223 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010224 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010225 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010226 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010228src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010229 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010230 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010231 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10232 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010233 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10234 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10235 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010237src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10238 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10239 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010240 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010241 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010242 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010244src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10245 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10246 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10247 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10248 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010249 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010251src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10252 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10253 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10254 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010255 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010257src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10258 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10259 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10260 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010261 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010262 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010264src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10265 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10266 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10267 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010268 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010269 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10270 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010271
10272 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010273 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010274 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010276src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10277 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10278 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10279 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10280 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010281 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10282 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010284src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10285 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10286 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010287 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10288 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010289 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010291src_port : integer
10292 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10293 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10294 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10295 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010297src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10298 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010299 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10300 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10301 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010302 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010304src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10305 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10306 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10307 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10308 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010309 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010311src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10312 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10313 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10314 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10315 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10316 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10317 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10318 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10319 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010320
10321 Example :
10322 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10323 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10324 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10325 listen ssh
10326 bind :22
10327 mode tcp
10328 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010329 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010330 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010331 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010333srv_id : integer
10334 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10335 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10336 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010337
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010338
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200103397.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010340----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010342The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10343closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10344when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10345usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010346future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010347
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010348ssl_bc : boolean
10349 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10350 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10351 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10352
10353ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10354 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10355 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10356
10357ssl_bc_cipher : string
10358 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10359 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10360
10361ssl_bc_protocol : string
10362 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10363 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10364
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010365ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010366 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010367 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10368 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010369
10370ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10371 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10372 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10373 if session was reused or not.
10374
10375ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10376 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10377 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010379ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10380 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10381 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10382 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10383 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10384 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010386ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10387 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10388 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10389 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10390 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010392ssl_c_err : integer
10393 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10394 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10395 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10396 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10397 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010399ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10400 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10401 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10402 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10403 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10404 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10405 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10406 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10407 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010409ssl_c_key_alg : string
10410 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10411 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10412 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010414ssl_c_notafter : string
10415 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10416 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10417 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010419ssl_c_notbefore : string
10420 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10421 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10422 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010424ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10425 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10426 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10427 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10428 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10429 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10430 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10431 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10432 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010434ssl_c_serial : binary
10435 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10436 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10437 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010439ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10440 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10441 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10442 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010444ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10445 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10446 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10447 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010449ssl_c_used : boolean
10450 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10451 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010453ssl_c_verify : integer
10454 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10455 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10456 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10457 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010459ssl_c_version : integer
10460 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10461 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010463ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10464 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10465 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10466 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10467 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010468 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010469 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10470 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10471 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010473ssl_f_key_alg : string
10474 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10475 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10476 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010478ssl_f_notafter : string
10479 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10480 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10481 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010483ssl_f_notbefore : string
10484 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10485 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10486 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010488ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10489 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10490 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10491 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10492 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10493 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10494 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10495 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10496 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010498ssl_f_serial : binary
10499 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10500 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10501 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010502
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010503ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10504 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10505 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10506 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010508ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10509 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10510 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10511 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010513ssl_f_version : integer
10514 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10515 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10516
10517ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010518 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10519 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10520 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010522 Example :
10523 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10524 listen http-https
10525 bind :80
10526 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10527 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10528
10529ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10530 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10531 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10532
10533ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010534 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010535 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10536 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10537 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10538 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10539 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10540 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10541 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10542 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010544ssl_fc_cipher : string
10545 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10546 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010548ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010549 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10550 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010551 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10552 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10553 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10554 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010556ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10557 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010558 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10559 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10560 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10561 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010563ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010564 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010565 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10566 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10567 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10568 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10569 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10570 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10571 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010573ssl_fc_protocol : string
10574 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10575 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010576
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010577ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010578 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010579 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10580 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010582ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10583 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10584 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10585 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10586 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010588ssl_fc_sni : string
10589 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10590 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10591 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10592 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10593 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10594
10595 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10596 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10597 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010598 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10599 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010601 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010602 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10603 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010605ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10606 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10607 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010608
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010609
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106107.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010611------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010613Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10614sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10615only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10616For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10617be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10618can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10619sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10620for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10621content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010623payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10624 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10625 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10626 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10629 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10630 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10631 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010633req.len : integer
10634req_len : integer (deprecated)
10635 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10636 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10637 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10638 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10639 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10640 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10641 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10642 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010644req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10645 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010646 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10647 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10648 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10649 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010651 ACL alternatives :
10652 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010654req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10655 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10656 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10657 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10658 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010660 ACL alternatives :
10661 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010663 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010665req.proto_http : boolean
10666req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10667 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10668 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10669 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10670 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10671 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10672 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10673 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010675 Example:
10676 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10677 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10678 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010679 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010681req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10682rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10683 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10684 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10685 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10686 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10687 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10688 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10689 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010691 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10692 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10693 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10694 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10695 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10696 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010698 ACL derivatives :
10699 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010701 Example :
10702 listen tse-farm
10703 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10704 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10705 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10706 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10707 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10708 persist rdp-cookie
10709 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10710 # This is only useful makes sense if
10711 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10712 stick-table type string size 204800
10713 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10714 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10715 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010717 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10718 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010720req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10721rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10722 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10723 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10724 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10725 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010727 ACL derivatives :
10728 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010730req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10731req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10732 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10733 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10734 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10735 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10736 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10737 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10738 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010740req.ssl_sni : string
10741req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10742 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10743 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10744 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10745 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10746 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10747 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10748 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10749 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10750 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10751 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10752 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10753 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010755 ACL derivatives :
10756 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010758 Examples :
10759 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10760 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10761 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10762 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10763 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010765res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10766rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10767 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10768 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10769 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10770 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10771 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10772 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10773 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010775req.ssl_ver : integer
10776req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10777 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10778 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10779 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10780 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10781 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10782 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10783 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10784 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10785 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010787 ACL derivatives :
10788 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010789
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010790res.len : integer
10791 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10792 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10793 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10794 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10795 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10796 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10797 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10798 content inspection.
10799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010800res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10801 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010802 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10803 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10804 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10805 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010807res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10808 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10809 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10810 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10811 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010813 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010815wait_end : boolean
10816 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10817 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10818 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10819 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10820 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10821 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10822 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10823 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010825 Examples :
10826 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10827 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10828 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010830 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10831 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10832 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10833 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10834 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10835 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10836 tcp-request content reject
10837
10838
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200108397.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010840--------------------------------------
10841
10842It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10843This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10844data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10845its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10846HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10847content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10848to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10849more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10850response are indexed.
10851
10852base : string
10853 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10854 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10855 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10856 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10857 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10858 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10859 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10860 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10861
10862 ACL derivatives :
10863 base : exact string match
10864 base_beg : prefix match
10865 base_dir : subdir match
10866 base_dom : domain match
10867 base_end : suffix match
10868 base_len : length match
10869 base_reg : regex match
10870 base_sub : substring match
10871
10872base32 : integer
10873 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10874 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10875 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10876 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10877
10878base32+src : binary
10879 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10880 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10881 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10882 per-URL counters.
10883
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010884capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10885 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10886 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10887 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
10888
10889capture.req.method : string
10890 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
10891 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
10892 because it's allocated.
10893
10894capture.req.uri : string
10895 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
10896 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
10897 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
10898 allocated.
10899
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010900capture.req.ver : string
10901 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10902 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
10903 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
10904
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010905capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10906 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10907 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10908 The first entry is an index of 0.
10909 See also: "capture response header"
10910
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010911capture.res.ver : string
10912 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10913 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
10914 persistent flag.
10915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010916req.cook([<name>]) : string
10917cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10918 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10919 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10920 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10921 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10922 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10923 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10924 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10925 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10926
10927 ACL derivatives :
10928 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10929 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10930 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10931 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10932 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10933 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10934 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10935 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010937req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10938cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10939 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10940 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010942req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10943cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10944 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10945 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10946 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10947 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010949cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10950 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10951 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10952 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10953 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10954 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10955 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10956 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10957 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10958 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10959 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010961hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10962 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10963 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10964 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10965 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010966 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10969 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10970 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10971 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10972 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10973 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10974 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10975 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10976 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010978req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10979 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10980 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10981 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10982 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010984req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10985 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10986 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10987 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10988 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10989 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10990 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10991 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10992 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10993 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10994 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10995 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010997 ACL derivatives :
10998 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10999 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11000 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11001 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11002 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11003 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11004 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11005 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11006
11007req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11008hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11009 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11010 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11011 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11012 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11013 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11014 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11015 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11016 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11017 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11018
11019req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11020hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11021 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11022 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11023 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11024 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11025 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11026 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11027 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11028 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11029
11030req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11031hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11032 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11033 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11034 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11035 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11036 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11037 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11038 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11039
11040http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11041 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11042 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11043 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11044 basic auth is supported.
11045
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011046http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11047 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11048 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11049 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11050 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011051 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11052 basic auth is supported.
11053
11054 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011055 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11056 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11057 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11058 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011059
11060http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011061 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11062 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011063 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11064 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011066method : integer + string
11067 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11068 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11069 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11070 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11071 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11072 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11073 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011075 ACL derivatives :
11076 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011078 Example :
11079 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11080 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11081 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011083path : string
11084 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11085 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11086 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11087 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11088 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11089 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11090 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011092 ACL derivatives :
11093 path : exact string match
11094 path_beg : prefix match
11095 path_dir : subdir match
11096 path_dom : domain match
11097 path_end : suffix match
11098 path_len : length match
11099 path_reg : regex match
11100 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011102req.ver : string
11103req_ver : string (deprecated)
11104 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11105 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11106 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011108 ACL derivatives :
11109 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011111res.comp : boolean
11112 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11113 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11114 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011116res.comp_algo : string
11117 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11118 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11119 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011121res.cook([<name>]) : string
11122scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11123 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11124 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11125 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011127 ACL derivatives :
11128 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011130res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11131scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11132 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11133 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11134 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011136res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11137scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11138 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11139 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11140 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011142res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11143 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11144 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11145 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11146 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11147 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11148 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11149 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11150 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11151 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011153res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11154 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11155 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11156 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11157 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11158 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011160res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11161shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11162 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11163 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11164 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11165 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11166 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11167 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11168 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11169 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011171 ACL derivatives :
11172 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11173 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11174 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11175 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11176 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11177 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11178 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11179 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11180
11181res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11182shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11183 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11184 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11185 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11186 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11187 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011189res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11190shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11191 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11192 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11193 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11194 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11195 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11196 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011198res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11199shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11200 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11201 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11202 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11203 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11204 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11205 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011207res.ver : string
11208resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11209 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11210 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011212 ACL derivatives :
11213 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011215set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11216 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11217 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11218 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11219 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011221 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11222 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011224 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011226status : integer
11227 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11228 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11229 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011231url : string
11232 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11233 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11234 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11235 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11236 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11237 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11238 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011240 ACL derivatives :
11241 url : exact string match
11242 url_beg : prefix match
11243 url_dir : subdir match
11244 url_dom : domain match
11245 url_end : suffix match
11246 url_len : length match
11247 url_reg : regex match
11248 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011250url_ip : ip
11251 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11252 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11253 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11254 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11255 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11256 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11257 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011259url_port : integer
11260 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11261 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11262 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11263 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011265urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11266url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11267 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11268 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11269 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11270 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11271 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11272 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11273 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11274 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11275 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011277 ACL derivatives :
11278 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11279 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11280 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11281 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11282 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11283 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11284 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11285 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011286
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011288 Example :
11289 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11290 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11291 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11292 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011294urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11295 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11296 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11297 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011298
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113007.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011301---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011303Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11304every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011305order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011307ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11308---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011309FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011310HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011311HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11312HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011313HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11314HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11315HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11316HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11317LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011318METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11319METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11320METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11321METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11322METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11323METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011324RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011325REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011326TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011327WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11328---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011329
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113318. Logging
11332----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011333
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011334One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11335provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11336very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11337provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11338state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011339to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011340headers.
11341
11342In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11343about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11344send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11345
11346 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11347 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11348 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11349 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11350 at the termination.
11351
11352The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11353allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11354as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11355while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11356real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11357delay.
11358
11359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113608.1. Log levels
11361---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011362
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011363TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011364source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011365HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11366in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11367track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11368syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11369about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011370
11371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113728.2. Log formats
11373----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011374
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011375HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011376and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11377slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11378options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011379
11380 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11381 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11382 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11383 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11384 extents.
11385
11386 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11387 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11388 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11389 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11390 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11391
11392 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11393 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11394 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11395 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11396 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11397
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011398 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11399 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11400 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11401 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11402
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011403 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11404
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011405Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11406specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11407field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11408servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11409always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11410identifier.
11411
11412Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11413 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11414 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11415 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11416 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11417
11418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114198.2.1. Default log format
11420-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011421
11422This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11423as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11424format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11425
11426 Example :
11427 listen www
11428 mode http
11429 log global
11430 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11431
11432 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11433 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11434 (www/HTTP)
11435
11436 Field Format Extract from the example above
11437 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11438 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11439 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11440 4 'to' to
11441 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11442 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11443
11444Detailed fields description :
11445 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11446 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11447 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11448 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11449 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11450 and processed the connection.
11451 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11452
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011453In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11454"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11455connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11456
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011457It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11458will eventually disappear.
11459
11460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114618.2.2. TCP log format
11462---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011463
11464The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11465is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11466information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11467counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11468emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11469environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11470the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11471sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011472specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11473not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11474fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11475marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011476
11477 Example :
11478 frontend fnt
11479 mode tcp
11480 option tcplog
11481 log global
11482 default_backend bck
11483
11484 backend bck
11485 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11486
11487 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11488 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11489 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11490
11491 Field Format Extract from the example above
11492 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11493 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11494 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11495 4 frontend_name fnt
11496 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11497 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11498 7 bytes_read* 212
11499 8 termination_state --
11500 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11501 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11502
11503Detailed fields description :
11504 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011505 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11506 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11507 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11508 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11509 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011510
11511 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011512 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11513 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11514 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011515
11516 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11517 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11518 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11519 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11520
11521 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11522 and processed the connection.
11523
11524 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11525 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11526 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11527 applications.
11528
11529 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11530 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11531 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11532 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11533 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11534
11535 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11536 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11537 See "Timers" below for more details.
11538
11539 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11540 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11541 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11542 "Timers" below for more details.
11543
11544 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011545 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011546 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11547 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11548 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11549 details.
11550
11551 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11552 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11553 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11554 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11555 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11556
11557 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11558 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11559 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11560 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11561 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11562 for more details.
11563
11564 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011565 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011566 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11567 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11568 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011569 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011570
11571 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11572 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11573 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11574 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11575 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11576 caused by a denial of service attack.
11577
11578 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11579 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11580 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11581 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11582 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11583 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11584 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11585 denial of service attack.
11586
11587 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11588 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11589 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11590 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11591 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11592 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11593 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11594 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11595 be processed than on other servers.
11596
11597 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11598 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11599 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11600 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11601 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11602 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11603 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11604 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11605 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11606 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11607 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11608 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11609 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11610
11611 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11612 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11613 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11614 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11615 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11616 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11617 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11618 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11619
11620 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11621 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11622 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11623 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11624 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11625 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11626 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11627 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11628 occurs.
11629
11630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116318.2.3. HTTP log format
11632----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011633
11634The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11635is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11636the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11637are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11638emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11639generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11640"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11641which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011642frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11643is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011644
11645Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11646slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11647with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11648
11649 Example :
11650 frontend http-in
11651 mode http
11652 option httplog
11653 log global
11654 default_backend bck
11655
11656 backend static
11657 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11658
11659 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11660 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11661 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011662 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011663
11664 Field Format Extract from the example above
11665 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11666 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11667 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11668 4 frontend_name http-in
11669 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11670 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11671 7 status_code 200
11672 8 bytes_read* 2750
11673 9 captured_request_cookie -
11674 10 captured_response_cookie -
11675 11 termination_state ----
11676 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11677 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11678 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11679 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11680 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011681
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011682
11683Detailed fields description :
11684 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011685 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11686 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11687 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11688 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11689 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011690
11691 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011692 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11693 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11694 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011695
11696 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11697 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11698 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11699 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11700 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11701
11702 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11703 and processed the connection.
11704
11705 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11706 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11707 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11708
11709 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11710 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11711 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11712 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11713 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11714 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11715
11716 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11717 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11718 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11719 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11720 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11721 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11722
11723 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11724 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11725 See "Timers" below for more details.
11726
11727 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11728 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11729 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11730 below for more details.
11731
11732 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11733 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11734 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11735 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11736 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11737 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11738 for more details.
11739
11740 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011741 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011742 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11743 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11744 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11745 details.
11746
11747 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11748 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11749 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11750
11751 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11752 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11753 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11754 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11755 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11756 overflowing.
11757
11758 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11759 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11760 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11761 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11762 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11763 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11764 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11765 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11766
11767 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11768 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11769 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11770 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11771 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11772 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11773 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11774 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11775
11776 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11777 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11778 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11779 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11780 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11781 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11782 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11783
11784 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011785 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011786 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11787 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11788 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011789 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011790 system.
11791
11792 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11793 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11794 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11795 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11796 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11797 caused by a denial of service attack.
11798
11799 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11800 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11801 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11802 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11803 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11804 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11805 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11806 denial of service attack.
11807
11808 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11809 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11810 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11811 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11812 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11813 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11814 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11815 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11816 processed than on other servers.
11817
11818 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11819 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11820 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11821 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11822 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11823 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11824 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11825 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11826 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11827 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11828 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11829 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11830 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11831
11832 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11833 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11834 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11835 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11836 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11837 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11838 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11839 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11840
11841 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11842 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11843 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11844 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11845 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11846 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11847 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11848 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11849 occurs.
11850
11851 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11852 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11853 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11854 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11855 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11856 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11857 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11858 cookies" below for more details.
11859
11860 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11861 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11862 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11863 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11864 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11865 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11866 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11867 and cookies" below for more details.
11868
11869 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11870 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11871 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11872 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11873 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11874 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11875 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11876 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11877
11878
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200118798.2.4. Custom log format
11880------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011881
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011882The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011883mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011884
11885HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11886Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11887separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11888prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11889
11890Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11891variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11892string formats ("Q").
11893
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011894If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011895as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011896less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11897the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11898
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011899Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011900In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011901in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011902
11903Flags are :
11904 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011905 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011906
11907 Example:
11908
11909 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11910 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11911
11912At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11913
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011914 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11915 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011916
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011917the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011918
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011919 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011920 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011921 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011922
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011923and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11924
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011925 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011926 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11927
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011928Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11929
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011930 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011931 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011932 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11933 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11934 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011935 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11936 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11937 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011938 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011939 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011940 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011941 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011942 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011943 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011944 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11945 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011946 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011947 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11948 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011949 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011950 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11951 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011952 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11953 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11954 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011955 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011956 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11957 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011958 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011959 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11960 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11961 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011962 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011963 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11964 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11965 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11966 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011967 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011968 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011969 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011970 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011971 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011972 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011973 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11974 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11975 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011976 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011977 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11978 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011979 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011980 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011981 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011982 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011983
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011984 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011985
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011986
119878.2.5. Error log format
11988-----------------------
11989
11990When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11991protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11992By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11993"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11994will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11995logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11996
11997The format looks like this :
11998
11999 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12000 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12001 Connection error during SSL handshake
12002
12003 Field Format Extract from the example above
12004 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12005 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12006 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12007 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12008 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12009
12010These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12011failures.
12012
12013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120148.3. Advanced logging options
12015-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012016
12017Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12018just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12019options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12020for more information about their usage.
12021
12022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120238.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12024------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012025
12026It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12027haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12028commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12029monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12030ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12031
12032 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12033 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12034 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12035 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12036
12037 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12038 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12039 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012040 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012041 such as other load-balancers.
12042
12043 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12044 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12045 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12046
12047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120488.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12049----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012050
12051The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12052what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12053or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12054"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12055just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12056log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12057after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12058is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12059with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12060with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12061
12062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120638.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12064------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012065
12066Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12067for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12068"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12069retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12070raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12071a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12072file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12073you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12074"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12075
12076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120778.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12078--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012079
12080Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12081multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12082them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12083"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12084logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12085error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12086and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12087too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12088useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12089alternative.
12090
12091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120928.4. Timing events
12093------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012094
12095Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12096reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12097the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12098frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12099mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12100
12101 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12102 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12103 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12104 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12105 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12106
12107 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12108 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12109 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12110 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12111 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12112
12113 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12114 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12115 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12116 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12117 connection never established.
12118
12119 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12120 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12121 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12122 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12123 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12124 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12125 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12126 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12127 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12128 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12129 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12130
12131 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12132 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12133 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12134 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012135 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012136
12137 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12138
12139 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12140 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12141 negative.
12142
12143These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12144protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12145that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012146due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012147close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12148session has been aborted on timeout.
12149
12150Most common cases :
12151
12152 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12153 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12154 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12155 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12156 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12157 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12158 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12159 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12160 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012161 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12162 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12163 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012164
12165 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12166 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12167 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12168 of ms on remote networks.
12169
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012170 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12171 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12172 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012173
12174 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12175 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12176 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12177 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12178 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12179 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12180 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12181 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12182 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12183 to the server until another one is released.
12184
12185Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12186
12187 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12188 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12189 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12190
12191 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12192 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12193 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12194
12195 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12196 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12197 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12198 flags.
12199
12200 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12201 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12202 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12203 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12204 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12205 the client connection was maintained open.
12206
12207 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012208 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012209 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12210 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12211
12212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122138.5. Session state at disconnection
12214-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012215
12216TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12217"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
122182-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12219each of which has a special meaning :
12220
12221 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12222 session to terminate :
12223
12224 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12225
12226 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12227 server explicitly refused it.
12228
12229 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12230 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12231 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12232 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012233 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12234
12235 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12236 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012237
12238 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12239 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12240 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12241 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12242 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12243
12244 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12245 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12246 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12247 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12248 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12249
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012250 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12251 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12252
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012253 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12254 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12255 backup connections when going up.
12256
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012257 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12258
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012259 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12260 send or receive data.
12261
12262 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12263 send or receive data.
12264
12265 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12266 with nothing left in the buffers.
12267
12268 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12269
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012270 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012271 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12272
12273 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12274 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12275 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12276 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12277 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12278
12279 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12280 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12281
12282 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12283 server (HTTP only).
12284
12285 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12286
12287 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12288 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12289 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12290
12291 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12292 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12293 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12294
12295 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12296
12297 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12298 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12299
12300 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12301 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12302 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12303
12304 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12305 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012306 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12307 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012308
12309 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12310 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12311 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12312 another server.
12313
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012314 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012315 server.
12316
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012317 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12318 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12319 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12320 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12321
12322 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12323 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12324 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12325 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12326
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012327 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12328 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12329 "use-server" rule).
12330
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012331 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12332
12333 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12334 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12335
12336 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12337
12338 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12339 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12340 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12341
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012342 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12343 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012344 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012345 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12346 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12347
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012348 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12349
12350 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12351 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12352
12353 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12354
12355 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12356
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012357The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12358was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012359helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12360starvation, attacks, etc...
12361
12362The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12363alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12364easier finding and understanding.
12365
12366 Flags Reason
12367
12368 -- Normal termination.
12369
12370 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12371 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12372 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12373 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12374
12375 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12376 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12377 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12378 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12379 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12380 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012381
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012382 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12383 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012384 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012385
12386 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12387 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12388 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12389
12390 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12391 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12392 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12393 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12394 the server takes too long to respond.
12395
12396 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12397 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12398 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12399 long a time to respond.
12400
12401 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12402 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12403 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12404 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12405 and the client.
12406
12407 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12408 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12409 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12410 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12411 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12412 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12413
12414 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12415 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012416 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12417 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12418 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12419 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012420
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012421 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12422 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012424 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012425 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12426 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12427 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12428 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12429 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12430
12431 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12432 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12433 503 or 504 here.
12434
12435 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12436 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12437 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12438 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12439 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12440
12441 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12442 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012443 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012444 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12445 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12446
12447 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12448 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12449 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12450 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12451 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12452 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12453 between haproxy and the server.
12454
12455 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12456 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12457 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12458 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12459 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12460 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12461 solution is to fix the application.
12462
12463 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12464 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12465 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12466 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12467 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12468 external attacks.
12469
12470 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12471 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012472 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012473 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12474 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12475
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012476 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12477 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12478 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012479 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12480 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012481
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012482 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12483 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12484 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12485 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012486 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12487 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12488 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12489 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12490 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012491
12492 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12493 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12494 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12495 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12496
12497 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12498 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12499 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12500 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12501
12502 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12503 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12504 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12505 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12506
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012507The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12508persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12509important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12510re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12511
12512 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12513
12514 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12515 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12516 set on a GET request.
12517
12518 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12519 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012520 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012521 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12522
12523 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12524 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12525 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12526
12527 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12528 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12529 already got a cookie.
12530
12531 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12532 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12533 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12534 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12535 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12536
12537 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12538 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12539 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12540
12541 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12542 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12543 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12544
12545 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12546 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12547
12548 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12549 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12550 then advertised in the response.
12551
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125538.6. Non-printable characters
12554-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012555
12556In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12557consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12558converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12559prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12560being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12561escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12562is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12563'}' when logging headers.
12564
12565Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12566issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12567containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12568
12569Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12570the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12571performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12572
12573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125748.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12575---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012576
12577Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12578achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012579section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012580cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12581the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12582the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012583locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012584not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12585user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12586a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12587wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12588
12589 Examples :
12590 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12591 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12592
12593 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12594 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12595
12596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12598---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012599
12600Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12601proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12602the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12603server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12604
12605Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12606response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012607section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012608
12609It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012610time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12611appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012612are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12613and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12614follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12615request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12616in the logs.
12617
12618 Example :
12619 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12620 listen proxy-out
12621 mode http
12622 option httplog
12623 option logasap
12624 log global
12625 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12626
12627 # log the name of the virtual server
12628 capture request header Host len 20
12629
12630 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12631 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12632
12633 # log the beginning of the referrer
12634 capture request header Referer len 20
12635
12636 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12637 capture response header Server len 20
12638
12639 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12640 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12641
12642 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12643 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12644
12645 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12646 capture response header Via len 20
12647
12648 # log the URL location during a redirection
12649 capture response header Location len 20
12650
12651 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12652 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12653 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12654 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12655 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12656
12657 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12658 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12659 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12660 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012661 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012662
12663 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12664 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12665 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12666 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12667 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012668 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012669
12670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126718.9. Examples of logs
12672---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012673
12674These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12675them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12676reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12677
12678 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12679 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12680 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12681
12682 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12683 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12684
12685 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12686 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12687 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12688
12689 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12690 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12691
12692 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12693 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12694 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12695
12696 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012697 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012698 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12699 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12700
12701 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12702 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12703 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12704
12705 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12706 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012707 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012708 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12709 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12710 to return the 502 and not the server.
12711
12712 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012713 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012714
12715 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12716 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12717 Nothing was sent to any server.
12718
12719 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12720 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12721
12722 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12723 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12724 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12725 send a 408 return code to the client.
12726
12727 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12728 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12729
12730 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12731 5 seconds ("c----").
12732
12733 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12734 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012735 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012736
12737 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012738 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012739 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12740 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12741 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12742 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12743 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012744
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127469. Statistics and monitoring
12747----------------------------
12748
12749It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12750mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12751CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12752Unix socket.
12753
12754
127559.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012756---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012757
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012758The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12759page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12760
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012761 0. pxname: proxy name
12762 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12763 for server)
12764 2. qcur: current queued requests
12765 3. qmax: max queued requests
12766 4. scur: current sessions
12767 5. smax: max sessions
12768 6. slim: sessions limit
12769 7. stot: total sessions
12770 8. bin: bytes in
12771 9. bout: bytes out
12772 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012773 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012774 12. ereq: request errors
12775 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012776 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012777 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12778 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012779 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012780 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12781 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12782 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12783 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12784 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12785 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12786 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12787 25. qlimit: queue limit
12788 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12789 27. iid: unique proxy id
12790 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12791 29. throttle: warm up status
12792 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12793 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012794 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012795 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12796 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12797 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012798 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012799 UNK -> unknown
12800 INI -> initializing
12801 SOCKERR -> socket error
12802 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12803 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12804 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12805 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12806 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12807 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12808 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12809 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12810 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12811 disable-on-404
12812 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12813 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12814 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012815 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12816 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012817 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12818 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12819 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12820 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12821 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12822 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012823 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12824 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12825 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12826 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012827 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12828 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012829 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12830 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12831 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012832 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012833 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012834
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128369.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012837-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012838
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012839The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12840necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12841A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12842issuing commands by hand :
12843
12844 global
12845 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12846 stats timeout 2m
12847
12848It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12849the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12850never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12851situations :
12852
12853 global
12854 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12855 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12856 stats timeout 2m
12857
12858To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12859swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12860to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12861syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12862
12863 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12864 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12865
12866The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12867script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12868for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12869
12870The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12871that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12872editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12873(eg: watch a counter).
12874
12875The socket supports two operation modes :
12876 - interactive
12877 - non-interactive
12878
12879The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12880this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12881sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12882mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12883commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12884example :
12885
12886 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12887
12888The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12889entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12890for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12891sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12892"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12893after processing the last command of the same line.
12894
12895For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12896"prompt" command :
12897
12898 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12899 prompt
12900 > show info
12901 ...
12902 >
12903
12904Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12905delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12906that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12907parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012908
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012909It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12910on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12911own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012912
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012913The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12914If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12915all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12916it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12917
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012918add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012919 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
12920 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
12921 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
12922 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012923
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012924add map <map> <key> <value>
12925 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12926 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012927 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
12928 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
12929 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012930
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012931clear counters
12932 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12933 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12934 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12935 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12936 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12937
12938clear counters all
12939 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12940 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12941 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12942
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012943clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012944 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
12945 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
12946 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012947
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012948clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012949 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
12950 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
12951 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012952
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012953clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12954 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12955
12956 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12957 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12958 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12959 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12960 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12961 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12962
12963 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12964
12965 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12966 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12967 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12968 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12969 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12970 the ACLs :
12971
12972 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12973 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12974 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12975 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12976 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12977 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12978
12979 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012980 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12981 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012982
12983 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012984 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012985 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012986 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12987 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12988 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12989 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012990
12991 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12992
12993 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012994 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012995 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12996 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012997 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12998 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12999 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013000
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013001del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13002 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013003 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13004 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13005 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13006 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013007
13008del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013009 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013010 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13011 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13012 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13013 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013014
13015disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013016 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13017
13018 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13019 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13020 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13021 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13022 re-enabled using enable agent.
13023
13024 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13025 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13026 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13027 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13028 otherwise unchanged.
13029
13030 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13031 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13032 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13033
13034 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13035 level "admin".
13036
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013037disable frontend <frontend>
13038 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13039 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13040 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13041 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13042 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13043 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13044 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13045 on the stats page.
13046
13047 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13048 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13049
13050 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13051 level "admin".
13052
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013053disable server <backend>/<server>
13054 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13055 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13056 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13057 during the maintenance.
13058
13059 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13060 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13061
13062 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013063 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013064
13065 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13066 level "admin".
13067
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013068enable agent <backend>/<server>
13069 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13070
13071 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13072 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13073
13074 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13075 level "admin".
13076
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013077enable frontend <frontend>
13078 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13079 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13080 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13081 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13082 which was disabled.
13083
13084 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13085 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13086
13087 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13088 level "admin".
13089
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013090enable server <backend>/<server>
13091 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13092 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13093
13094 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013095 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013096
13097 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13098 level "admin".
13099
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013100get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013101get acl <acl> <value>
13102 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13103 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13104 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13105 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13106 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013107
13108 The first two words are:
13109
13110 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13111 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13112 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13113
13114 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13115
13116 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13117
13118 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13119
13120 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13121 interpretation of the case.
13122
13123 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13124 useful with regular expressions.
13125
13126 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13127 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13128
13129 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13130 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13131 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13132
13133 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13134
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013135get weight <backend>/<server>
13136 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13137 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13138 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13139 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13140 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013141 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013142
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013143help
13144 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13145 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013146
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013147prompt
13148 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13149 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13150 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13151 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13152 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13153 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13154 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13155 command.
13156
13157quit
13158 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013159
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013160set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013161 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13162 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13163 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013164
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013165set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013166 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13167 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13168 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13169 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13170 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013171 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13172 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13173
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013174set maxconn global <maxconn>
13175 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13176 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13177 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13178 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13179 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13180 setting.
13181
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013182set rate-limit connections global <value>
13183 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13184 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13185 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13186 is passed in number of connections per second.
13187
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013188set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13189 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13190 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013191 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13192 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013193
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013194set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13195 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13196 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13197 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13198 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13199
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013200set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13201 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13202 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13203 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13204 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13205 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13206
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013207set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013208 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13209 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13210 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13211 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013212 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13213 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013214
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013215set timeout cli <delay>
13216 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13217 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13218 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13219
13220set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13221 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13222 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013223 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13224 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13225 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13226 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13227 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13228 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13229 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13230 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13231 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13232 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13233 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13234 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13235 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013236
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013237show errors [<iid>]
13238 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13239 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013240 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13241 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13242 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013243
13244 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13245 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13246 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13247 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13248 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13249 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13250 are reported too.
13251
13252 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13253 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13254 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13255 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13256 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13257 code.
13258
13259 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13260 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13261 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13262 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13263 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13264 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13265 line.
13266
13267 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013268 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13269 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013270 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13271 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13272
13273 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13274 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13275 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13276 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13277 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13278 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13279 00204+ minal\r\n
13280 00211 \r\n
13281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013282 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013283 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13284 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13285 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13286 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13287 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13288 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013289
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013290show info
13291 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13292
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013293show map [<map>]
13294 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013295 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13296 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13297 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13298 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13299 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13300 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013301
13302show acl [<acl>]
13303 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013304 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13305 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13306 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13307 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13308 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013309
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013310show pools
13311 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13312 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13313 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13314 the pools.
13315
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013316show sess
13317 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013318 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13319 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13320
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013321show sess <id>
13322 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13323 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13324 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13325 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13326 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013327 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13328 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13329 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013330
13331show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13332 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13333 possible to dump only selected items :
13334 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13335 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13336 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13337 for example:
13338 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13339 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13340 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13341
13342 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013343 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13344 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013345 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13346 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13347 Nbproc: 1
13348 Process_num: 1
13349 (...)
13350
13351 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13352 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13353 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13354 (...)
13355 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13356
13357 $
13358
13359 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13360 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13361 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13362 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013363 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013364
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013365show table
13366 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13367 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13368 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13369 entries currently in use.
13370
13371 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013372 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013373 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13374 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013375
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013376show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013377 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13378 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13379 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013380 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13381
13382 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13383 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13384 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13385 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13386 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13387
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013388 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13389 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13390 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13391 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13392 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13393 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13394
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013395
13396 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013397 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13398 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013399
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013400 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013401 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013402 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013403 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13404 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13405 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13406 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013407
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013408 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013409 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013410 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13411 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013412
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013413 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13414 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013415 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013416 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13417 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013418
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013419 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13420 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013421 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013422 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13423 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13424
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013425 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13426 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13427 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13428 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13429 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13430
13431 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13432 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13433 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013434 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13435 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013436 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13437 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013438
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013439shutdown frontend <frontend>
13440 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13441 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13442 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13443 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13444 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13445 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13446 once it is terminated.
13447
13448 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13449 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13450
13451 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13452 level "admin".
13453
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013454shutdown session <id>
13455 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13456 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13457 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13458 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13459 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13460 flag in the logs.
13461
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013462shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13463 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13464 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13465 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13466 'K' flag in the logs.
13467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013468/*
13469 * Local variables:
13470 * fill-column: 79
13471 * End:
13472 */